blob: 9307437c647ceef94682b83cbad6579248161a4b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau910d5ac2019-12-21 12:45:18 +01007 2019/12/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
852 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3670 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3719 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3751 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004216http-check send-state
4217 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments : none
4221
4222 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4223 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4224 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4225 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4226 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4227
4228 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4229 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4230 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4231 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4232 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004233 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4234 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4235 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4236
4237 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4238 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4239 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4240
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004241 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4242 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4243 checked in multiple backends.
4244
4245 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4246 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4247
4248 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4249 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4250 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4251 one fails.
4252
4253 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4254 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4255 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4256
4257 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4258 server's queue.
4259
4260 Example of a header received by the application server :
4261 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4262 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4263
4264 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266
4267http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004268 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4269
4270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004273 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4274 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4275 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4276 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4277 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4280 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4285 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4286 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4287 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4290 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4291 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4292 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 Example:
4295 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4296 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 http-request allow if nagios
4300 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4301 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4302 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 Example:
4305 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4306 acl add path /addacl
4307 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4312 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 Example:
4315 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4316 acl setmap path /setmap
4317 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4322 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4325 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4330 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4331 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4332 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4333 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4334 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4335 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4341 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4342 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4343 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4344 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4345 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4346 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4347 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4358 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4359 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4360 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4361 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 Example:
4364 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4365 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004367http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4375 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4376 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4377 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4378 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4379 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4380 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4381 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4382 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4385 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4386 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004387 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4388
4389 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4390 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4391 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4392 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4397 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4398 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4399 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4400 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4401 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4410 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4411 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4412 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4413 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4414 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4419 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4420 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4421 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4422 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004423
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004424http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4426 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4427 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4428
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004429http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4430
4431 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4432 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4433 pointed by <resolvers>.
4434 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4435 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4436 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4437 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4438 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4439 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4440 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4441 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4442 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4443 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4444 to 0.0.0.0.
4445
4446 Example:
4447 resolvers mydns
4448 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4449 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4450 timeout retry 1s
4451 hold valid 10s
4452 hold nx 3s
4453 hold other 3s
4454 hold obsolete 0s
4455 accepted_payload_size 8192
4456
4457 frontend fe
4458 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4459 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4460 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4461
4462 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4463 # which mean DNS resolution error
4464 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4465
4466 default_backend be
4467
4468 backend b_503
4469 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4470 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4471 # 503 error page to end users
4472
4473 backend be
4474 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4475 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4476 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4477 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4478 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4479
4480 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4481 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4482
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004483http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4484
4485 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4486 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4487 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4488 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004489 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4490 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004491
4492 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4497 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4498 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4499 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4500 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4505 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4506 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4507 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4510 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004511
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004512 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4513 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4514 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4515 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4516 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4517 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004518
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004519 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4520 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4521 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4522 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4523 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004524
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004525 Example:
4526 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4527
4528 # applied to:
4529 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4530
4531 # outputs:
4532 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4533
4534 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004535
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004536 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4537
4538 # applied to:
4539 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004540
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004541 # outputs:
4542 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004543
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004544http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4546
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004547 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4548 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4549 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4550 against.
4551
4552 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4553 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4554 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004555
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004556 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4557 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4558 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4559 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4560 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4561 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4562 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4563 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4564 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
4565 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004566
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004567 Example:
4568 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4569 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004570
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004571 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4572 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004576
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004577 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4578 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4579 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4580 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004581
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004582 Example:
4583 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004584
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004585 # applied to:
4586 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004587
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004588 # outputs:
4589 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4592http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4595 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4596 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4601 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4602 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4607 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4608 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4609 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4610 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 Arguments:
4613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4614 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616 Example:
4617 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4618 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4621 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4626 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4627 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 Arguments:
4630 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4631 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004633 Example:
4634 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4635 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4638 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4639 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4644 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4645 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4646 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4647 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 Example:
4650 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4651 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4652 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4653 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4654 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4655 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4656 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4657 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4658 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4663 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4664 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4665 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4666 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4672 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4673 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4674 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4675 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4676 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4677 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4678 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4679 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004681http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004683 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4684 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4685 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4686 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4687 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4688 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4689 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4694 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4695 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004699 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4700 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4701 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4702 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4703 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4704 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4705 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4706 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004708http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004710 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4711 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4712 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4713 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4714 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4715 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717 Example :
4718 # prepend the host name before the path
4719 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4724 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4725 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4726 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4727 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004729http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4732 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4733 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4734 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4735 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4736 values have higher priority.
4737 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4738 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4739 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4740 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4741 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004745 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4746 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4747 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4748 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4749 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4750 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4751 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004753 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004754
4755 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4757 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4760 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4761 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4762 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4763 privacy.
4764
4765 Arguments :
4766 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4767 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004768
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004769 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4771 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4772
4773 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4774 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4775
4776http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4777
4778 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4779 expression.
4780
4781 Arguments:
4782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4783 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004784
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004785 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004786 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4787 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4788
4789 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4790 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4791 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4792
4793http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4794
4795 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4796 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4797 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4798 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4799 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4800 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4801 information from the request.
4802
4803 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4804
4805http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4806
4807 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4808 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4809 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4810 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4811 path and the query string.
4812 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4813
4814http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4815
4816 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4817 inline.
4818
4819 Arguments:
4820 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4821 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4822 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4825 (request and response)
4826 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4827 processing
4828 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4829 processing
4830 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4831 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4832 and '_'.
4833
4834 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4835 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004836
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004837 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004838 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004840http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4841 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4844 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4845 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4846 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4847 agent name must be used.
4848
4849 Arguments:
4850 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4851
4852 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4853 configuration.
4854
4855http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4856
4857 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4858 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4859 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4860 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4861 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4862 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4863 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4864 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4865 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4866 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4867 action.
4868 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4869 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4870 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4871 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4872 you fully understand how it works.
4873
4874http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4875
4876 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4877 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4878 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4879 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4880 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4881 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4882 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4883 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4884 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4885 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4886 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4887 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4888 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4889
4890http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4891http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4892http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4893
4894 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4895 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4896 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4897 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4898 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4899 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4900 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4901 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4902 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4903 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4904 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4905 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4906
4907 Arguments :
4908 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4909 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4910 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4911 select which table entry to update the counters.
4912
4913 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4914 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4915 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4916 that table until the session ends.
4917
4918 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4919 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4920 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4921 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4922 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4923 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4924 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4925 useful information.
4926
4927 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4928 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4929 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4930 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4931 checks that make use of it.
4932
4933http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004936
4937 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004938 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004939
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004940http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4941
4942 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4943 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4944 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4945 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4946 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4947 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4948
4949 Arguments :
4950 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4951
4952 Example:
4953 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004955http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004957 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4958 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4959 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004960
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004963 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4964
4965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 no | yes | yes | yes
4967
4968 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4969 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4970 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4971 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4972 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4973 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4976 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4981 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4982 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4983 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4986 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4987 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4988 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 Example:
4991 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004995 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4996 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998 Example:
4999 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5004 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005006 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5007 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005009http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005011 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5012 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5013 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5014 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5015 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5016 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5017 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5018 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005020http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5023 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5024 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5025 example, or to pass some internal information.
5026 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5027 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5028 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5033 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005034
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005035http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5042 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5043 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5044 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5045 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5046 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5047 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5050 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5051 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5052 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5053 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005054
5055 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5056 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5057 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5058 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5063 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5064 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5065 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5066 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5067 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005075 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5076 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5077 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5078 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5079 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5080 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005082http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5085 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005089 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5090 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5091 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5092 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5093 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5094 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005098
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005099 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5100 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102 Example:
5103 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 # applied to:
5106 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005108 # outputs:
5109 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005111 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5114 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005115
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005116 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5117 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119 Example:
5120 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005122 # applied to:
5123 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125 # outputs:
5126 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5129http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5132 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5133 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005135http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5138 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5139 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5144 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5145 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5146 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5147 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005149 Arguments:
5150 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005152 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5153 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005155http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5158 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5159 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5162
5163 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5164 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5165 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5166 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5167 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5168
5169http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5170
5171 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5172 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5173 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5174 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5175 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5176 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5177 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5178 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5179 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5180
5181http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5182
5183 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5184 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5185 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5186 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5187 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5188 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5189 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5190
5191http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5192
5193 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5194 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5195 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5196 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5197 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5198 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5199 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5200 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5201
5202http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5204
5205 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5206 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5207 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5208 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005209
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005210 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5212 http-response set-status 431
5213 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5214 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005216http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005218 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5219 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5220 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5221 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5222 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5223 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5224 based on some information from the request.
5225
5226 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5227
5228http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5229
5230 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5231 inline.
5232
5233 Arguments:
5234 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5235 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5239 (request and response)
5240 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5241 processing
5242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5243 processing
5244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5245 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5246 and '_'.
5247
5248 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5249 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005250
5251 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005252 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005254http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005255
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005256 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5257 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5258 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5259 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5260 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5261 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5262 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5263 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5264 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5265 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5266 action.
5267 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5268 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5269 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5270 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5271 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005273http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5274http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5275http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005277 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5278 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5279 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5280 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5281 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5282 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5283
5284http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5287 about <var-name>.
5288
5289 Example:
5290 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5291
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005292
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005293http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5294 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5295
5296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5297 yes | no | yes | yes
5298
5299 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005300 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5301 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5302 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005303
5304 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5305
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005306 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5307 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5308 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5309 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5310 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5311 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5312 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5313 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5314 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5315 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005316
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005317 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5318 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5319 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5320 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5321 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5322 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5323 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5324 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005325
5326 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5327 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5328 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5329 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5330 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5331 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5332 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5333 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005334 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005335 downsides of rare connection failures.
5336
5337 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5338 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5339 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5340 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5341 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5342 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005343 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005344 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5345 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5346 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5347 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5348 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5349
5350 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5352 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5353 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005354
5355 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005356 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005357
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005358 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5359 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005360
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005361 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005362
5363 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5364 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5365 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5366
5367 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5368
5369
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005370http-send-name-header [<header>]
5371 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005374 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005375 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5376
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005377 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5378 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5379 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5380 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5381 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5382 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5383 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5384 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5385 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5386 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5387 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5388 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5389 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5390 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5391 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5392 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005393
5394 See also : "server"
5395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005396id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005397 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5399 no | yes | yes | yes
5400 Arguments : none
5401
5402 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5403 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5404 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005405
5406
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005407ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5408 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005410 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005411
5412 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5413 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5414 and running).
5415
5416 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5417 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5418 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005419 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005420 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5421
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005422 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5423 "unless" condition is met.
5424
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005425 Example:
5426 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5427 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5428 ignore-persist if url_static
5429
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005430 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5431
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005432load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5433 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 yes | no | yes | yes
5436
5437 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5438 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5439 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005440 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005441 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5442 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5443 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5444 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5445
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005446 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005447 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005448 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005449
5450 Arguments:
5451 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5452 named "server-state-file".
5453
5454 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5455 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5456 name is used as a file name.
5457
5458 none don't load any stat for this backend
5459
5460 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005461 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5462 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5463 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005464 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005465 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005466
5467 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5468 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5469
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005470 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005471
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005472 global
5473 stats socket /tmp/socket
5474 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005475
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005476 defaults
5477 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005478
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005479 backend bk
5480 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5481 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005482
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005483
5484 Then one can run :
5485
5486 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5487
5488 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5489
5490 1
5491 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5492 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5493 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5494
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005495 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005496
5497 global
5498 stats socket /tmp/socket
5499 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5500
5501 defaults
5502 load-server-state-from-file local
5503
5504 backend bk
5505 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5506 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5507
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005508
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005509 Then one can run :
5510
5511 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5512
5513 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5514
5515 1
5516 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5517 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5518 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5519
5520 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5521 "show servers state"
5522
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005524log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005525log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5526 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005527no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005528 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005531
5532 Prefix :
5533 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5534 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5535 prefix does not allow arguments.
5536
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005537 Arguments :
5538 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5539 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5540 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5541 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5542 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5543 parameter.
5544
5545 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5546 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5547
5548 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5549 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5550 standard syslog port).
5551
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005552 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5553 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5554 standard syslog port).
5555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5557 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5558 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005559 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005561 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5562 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5563 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5564 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5565 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5566 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5567 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5568 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5569 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5570 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5571 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5572 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5573 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5574 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5575 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5576 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005577 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5578 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005579
5580 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5581 and "fd@2", see above.
5582
5583 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5584 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005585
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005586 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5587 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5588 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5589 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5590 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5591 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5592 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5593 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5594 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5595 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005596 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005597
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005598 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5599 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5600 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5601 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5602 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5603
5604 <sample_size>
5605 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5606 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5607 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5608 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5609 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5610
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005611 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5612 one of the following :
5613
5614 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5615 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5616
5617 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5618 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5619
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005620 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5621 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5622 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5623 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5624 systemd logger consumes.
5625
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005626 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5627 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5628 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5629 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5632
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005633 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5634 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5635 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5636
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005637 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5638 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5639 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5640 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005641
5642 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5643 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5644 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005645 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5646 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5647 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5648 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5649 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005650
5651 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5652
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005653 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5654 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5655 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005656
5657 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5658 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5659 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5660 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5661
5662 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5663 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005664
5665 Example :
5666 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005667 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5668 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5669 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005670 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5671 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005672 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005673
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005674
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005675log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005676 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5677 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005679
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005680 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5681 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5682 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5683 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5684 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005685
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005686 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5687 "option httplog" directives.
5688
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005689log-format-sd <string>
5690 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5692 yes | yes | yes | no
5693
5694 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5695 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5696 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5697 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5698 which covers the log format string in depth.
5699
5700 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5701 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5702
5703 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5704 log format to "rfc5424".
5705
5706 Example :
5707 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5708
5709
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005710log-tag <string>
5711 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | yes | yes | yes
5714
5715 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5716 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5717 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5718 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5719 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5720 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5721 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5722 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5723 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005725max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5726 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5728 yes | no | yes | yes
5729
5730 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5731 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5732 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5733 servers.
5734
5735 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5736 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5737 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5738 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5739 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005740 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005741 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5742 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5743 picking a different server.
5744
5745 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5746 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5747 even if they have to be queued.
5748
5749 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5750 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5751
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005752max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5753 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5754 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5755 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005756
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005757maxconn <conns>
5758 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | yes | yes | no
5761 Arguments :
5762 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5763 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5764 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5765 closes.
5766
5767 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5768 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5769 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5770 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005771 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5772 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5773 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5774 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005775
5776 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5777 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5778 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5779
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005780 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5781 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005782
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005783 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5784
5785
5786mode { tcp|http|health }
5787 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | yes | yes | yes
5790 Arguments :
5791 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5792 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5793 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5794 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5795
5796 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5797 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5798 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5799 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5800 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5801
5802 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005803 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5804 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5805 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5806 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5807 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5808 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5809 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005810
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005811 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5812 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5813 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005814
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005815 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005816 defaults http_instances
5817 mode http
5818
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005819 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005821
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005822monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005823 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005826 Arguments :
5827 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5828 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005829 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005830 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5831 backend and its backup.
5832
5833 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5834 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5835 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5836 servers in a list of backends.
5837
5838 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5839 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5840 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5841 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5842 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5843 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5844 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005845 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5846 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005847
5848 Example:
5849 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005850 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005851 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5852 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5853 monitor-uri /site_alive
5854 monitor fail if site_dead
5855
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005856 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005857
5858
5859monitor-net <source>
5860 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | yes | yes | no
5863 Arguments :
5864 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5865 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5866 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5867 followed by a mask.
5868
5869 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5870 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005871 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5873
5874 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5875 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5876 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5877 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005878 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5879 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5880 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005881
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005882 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5883 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5884 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5885 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5886 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5887 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005888
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005889 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5890 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005892 Example :
5893 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5894 frontend www
5895 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5896
5897 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5898
5899
5900monitor-uri <uri>
5901 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 yes | yes | yes | no
5904 Arguments :
5905 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5906 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5907
5908 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5909 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5910 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5911 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5912 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5913 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5914 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5915 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5916
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005917 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5918 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5919 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5920 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5921 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5922 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5923 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5924 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005925
5926 Example :
5927 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5928 frontend www
5929 mode http
5930 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5931
5932 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005934
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005935option abortonclose
5936no option abortonclose
5937 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5939 yes | no | yes | yes
5940 Arguments : none
5941
5942 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5943 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5944 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5945 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005946 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005947 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5948 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5949 encountered while delivering the response.
5950
5951 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5952 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5953 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5954 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5955 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5956 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005957 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005958 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005959 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005960 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5961 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5962 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5963
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005964 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5965 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005966 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5967 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5968 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5969 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5970 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5971 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005972 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005973
5974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5976
5977 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5978
5979
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005980option accept-invalid-http-request
5981no option accept-invalid-http-request
5982 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5984 yes | yes | yes | no
5985 Arguments : none
5986
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005987 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005988 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005989 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005990 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5991 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5992 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5993 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5994 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005995 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5996 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5997 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5998 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005999 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006000 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006001 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6002 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6003 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006004
6005 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6006 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6007 been confirmed.
6008
6009 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6010 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006011 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6012 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006013 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6014
6015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6017
6018 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6019 stats socket.
6020
6021
6022option accept-invalid-http-response
6023no option accept-invalid-http-response
6024 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | no | yes | yes
6027 Arguments : none
6028
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006029 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006030 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006032 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6033 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6034 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6035 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6036 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006037 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6038 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6039 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006040
6041 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6042 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6043 been confirmed.
6044
6045 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6046 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6047 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6048 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6049
6050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6052
6053 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6054 stats socket.
6055
6056
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006057option allbackups
6058no option allbackups
6059 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | no | yes | yes
6062 Arguments : none
6063
6064 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6065 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6066 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6067 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6068 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6069 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6070 order between the backup servers anymore.
6071
6072 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6073 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6074
6075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6077
6078
6079option checkcache
6080no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006081 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6083 yes | no | yes | yes
6084 Arguments : none
6085
6086 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6087 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006088 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006089 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6090 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006091 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006092
6093 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006094 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006095 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006096 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6097 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006098 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006099 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006100 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6101 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006102 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006103 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6104 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006105 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006106 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6107 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6108 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6109 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6110 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6111 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6112 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6113 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6114 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6115
6116 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006117 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006119 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006120 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6121
6122 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6123 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006124 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006125 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006126
6127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6129
6130
6131option clitcpka
6132no option clitcpka
6133 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 yes | yes | yes | no
6136 Arguments : none
6137
6138 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6139 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006140 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006141 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6142
6143 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6144 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6145 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6146 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6147
6148 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6149 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6150 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6151 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6152 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6153
6154 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6155
6156 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6157 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6158 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6159
6160 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6161 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6162
6163 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6164
6165
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006166option contstats
6167 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6169 yes | yes | yes | no
6170 Arguments : none
6171
6172 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6173 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6174 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6175 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006176 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6177 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6178 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6179 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6180 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006181
6182
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006183option dontlog-normal
6184no option dontlog-normal
6185 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6187 yes | yes | yes | no
6188 Arguments : none
6189
6190 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6191 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6192 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6193 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6194 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6195 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6196 logged.
6197
6198 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6199 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6200 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006202 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006203 logging.
6204
6205
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006206option dontlognull
6207no option dontlognull
6208 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6210 yes | yes | yes | no
6211 Arguments : none
6212
6213 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6214 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6215 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6216 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6217 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6218 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006219 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6220 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6221 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006222
6223 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006224 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006225 would not be logged.
6226
6227 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6228 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6229
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006230 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6231 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006232
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006233
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006234option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006235 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 yes | yes | yes | yes
6238 Arguments :
6239 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6240 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006241 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006242 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006243
6244 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6245 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6246 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6247 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6248 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6249 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6250 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006251 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6252 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6253 possible that the client has already brought one.
6254
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006255 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006256 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006257 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006258 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006259 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006260 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006261
6262 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6263 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6264 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6265 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6266 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6267 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6268 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6269
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006270 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6271 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6272 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6273 are under the control of the end-user.
6274
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006275 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006276 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6277 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006278 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6279 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6280 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006281
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006282 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006283 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6284 frontend www
6285 mode http
6286 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6287
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006288 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6289 backend www
6290 mode http
6291 option forwardfor header X-Client
6292
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006293 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006294 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006295
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006296
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006297option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6298no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6299 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 yes | yes | yes | no
6302 Arguments : none
6303
6304 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6305 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6306 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6307 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6308 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6309 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6310 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6311
6312 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6313 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6314 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6315 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6316 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6317 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6318 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6319 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6320 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6321 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6322
6323 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6324
6325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6327
6328 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6329 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6330
6331
6332option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6333no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6334 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | no | yes | yes
6337 Arguments : none
6338
6339 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6340 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6341 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6342 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6343 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6344 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6345 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6346
6347 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6348 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6349 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6350 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6351 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6352 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6353 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6354 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6355 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6356 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6357
6358 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6359
6360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6362
6363 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6364 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6365
6366
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006367option http-buffer-request
6368no option http-buffer-request
6369 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6371 yes | yes | yes | yes
6372 Arguments : none
6373
6374 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6375 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6376 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6377 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6378 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6379 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6380 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6381 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006382 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006383 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6384 default.
6385
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006386 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006387
6388
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006389option http-ignore-probes
6390no option http-ignore-probes
6391 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6393 yes | yes | yes | no
6394 Arguments : none
6395
6396 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6397 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6398 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6399 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6400 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6401 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6402 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6403 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6404 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006405 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6406 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006407 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6408
6409 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6410 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6411 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6412 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6413 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6414 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6415 are often the only way to detect them.
6416
6417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6419
6420 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6421
6422
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006423option http-keep-alive
6424no option http-keep-alive
6425 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6427 yes | yes | yes | yes
6428 Arguments : none
6429
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006430 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6431 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006432 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6433 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6434 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6435 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6436 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006437
6438 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6439 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006440 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6441 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6442 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6443 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6444 situations where this option may be useful :
6445
6446 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006447 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006448
6449 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6450 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6451
6452 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6453 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6454 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6455 request.
6456
6457 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6458 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006459 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6460 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6461 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006462
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006463 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6464 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6465 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6466 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6467 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6468 not set.
6469
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006470 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006471 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6472 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006473
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006474 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006475 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006476 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006477
6478
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006479option http-no-delay
6480no option http-no-delay
6481 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | yes | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
6486 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6487 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6488 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6489 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6490 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6491 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6492 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6493 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6494 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6495 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6496 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6497 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6498 affected.
6499
6500 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6501 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6502 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6503 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6504 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6505 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6506 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6507 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6508 latency environments.
6509
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006510 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6511
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006512
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006513option http-pretend-keepalive
6514no option http-pretend-keepalive
6515 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006517 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006518 Arguments : none
6519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006520 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006521 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6522 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6523 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6524 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6525 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6526 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6527 consider the response complete.
6528
6529 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6530 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6531 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6532 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006533 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006534 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6535
6536 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6537 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6538 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6539 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6540 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6541 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6542 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6543
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006544 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6545 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6546 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6547 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6548 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6549 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006550
6551 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6552 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6553
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006554 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006555 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006556
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006557
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006558option http-server-close
6559no option http-server-close
6560 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | yes | yes | yes
6563 Arguments : none
6564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006565 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6566 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6567 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6568 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006569 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6570 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6571 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6572 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6573 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6574 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6575 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6576 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6577 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6578 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6579 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006580
6581 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6582 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6583 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6584 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006585 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6586 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006587
6588 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6589 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006590 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6591 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6592 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006593
6594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6596
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006597 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6598 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006599
6600
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006601option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6602no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6603 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006605 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006606 Arguments : none
6607
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006608 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6609 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6610 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6611
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006612 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6613 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6614 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6615 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006616 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006617
6618 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006619 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006620 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6621 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6622 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6623 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6624 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6625 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6626 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006627
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006628 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6629 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6630 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6631 backend.
6632
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006633 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6634 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6635
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006636 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6637 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006638
6639
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006640option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006641no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006642 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 yes | yes | yes | no
6645 Arguments : none
6646
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006647 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006648 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6649 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6650 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6651 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6652 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6653 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6654
6655 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6656 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006657 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6658 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6659 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006660
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006661 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6662 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6663 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6664 front of an existing proxy.
6665
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006666 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006668 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006669
6670
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006671option http-use-htx
6672no option http-use-htx
6673 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6675 yes | yes | yes | yes
6676 Arguments : none
6677
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006678 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006679 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006680 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6681 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6682 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6683 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6684 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006685
6686 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6687 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6688 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6689 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006690 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6691 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6692 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6693 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006694
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006695 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6696 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6697 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6698 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6699 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006700
6701 See also : "mode http"
6702
6703
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006704option httpchk
6705option httpchk <uri>
6706option httpchk <method> <uri>
6707option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6708 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | no | yes | yes
6711 Arguments :
6712 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6713 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6714 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6715 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6716 ones.
6717
6718 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6719 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6720 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6721
6722 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6723 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6724 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6725 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6726 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6727
6728 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6729 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6730 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6731 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6732 the lack of any response.
6733
6734 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6735
6736 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6737 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6738 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6739
6740 Examples :
6741 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6742 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6743 backend https_relay
6744 mode tcp
6745 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6746 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6747
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006748 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6749 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6750 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006751
6752
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006753option httpclose
6754no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006755 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | yes | yes | yes
6758 Arguments : none
6759
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006760 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6761 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6762 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6763 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006764 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006765
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006766 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6767 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006768 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006769 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6770 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006772 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6773 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6774 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006775
6776 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6777 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006778 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006779 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6780 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6781 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006782
6783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006786 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006787
6788
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006789option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006790 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006792 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006793 Arguments :
6794 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6795 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6796 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006797 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006798 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006799
6800 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6801 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6802 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6803 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6804 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6805 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6806 ports.
6807
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006808 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6809 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006810
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006811 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006813 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006814
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006815
6816option http_proxy
6817no option http_proxy
6818 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | yes | yes | yes
6821 Arguments : none
6822
6823 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6824 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6825 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6826 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6827 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6828
6829 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6830 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006831 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6832 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006833
6834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6836
6837 Example :
6838 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6839 backend direct_forward
6840 option httpclose
6841 option http_proxy
6842
6843 See also : "option httpclose"
6844
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006845
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006846option independent-streams
6847no option independent-streams
6848 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 yes | yes | yes | yes
6851 Arguments : none
6852
6853 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6854 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6855 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6856 receive data or not.
6857
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006858 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006859 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6860 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6861 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6862 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6863 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6864 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6865 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6866 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6867 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6868 socket buffers.
6869
6870 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6871 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6872 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6873 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6874 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6875
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006876 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006877 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6878 deprecated.
6879
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006880 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006881
6882
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006883option ldap-check
6884 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6886 yes | no | yes | yes
6887 Arguments : none
6888
6889 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6890 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6891 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6892 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6893
6894 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6895 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6896
6897 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6898 configure it.
6899
6900 Example :
6901 option ldap-check
6902
6903 See also : "option httpchk"
6904
6905
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006906option external-check
6907 Use external processes for server health checks
6908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 yes | no | yes | yes
6910
6911 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6912 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6913 command".
6914
6915 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6916
6917 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6918
6919
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006920option log-health-checks
6921no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006922 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | no | yes | yes
6925 Arguments : none
6926
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006927 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6928 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6929 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006930
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006931 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6932 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6933 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6934 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6935 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6936
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006937 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006938 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006939
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006940 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6941 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6942 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006943
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006944
6945option log-separate-errors
6946no option log-separate-errors
6947 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | yes | yes | no
6950 Arguments : none
6951
6952 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6953 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6954 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6955 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6956 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6957 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6958 provides very important information.
6959
6960 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6961 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6962 error logs.
6963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006964 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006965 logging.
6966
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006967
6968option logasap
6969no option logasap
6970 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | yes | yes | no
6973 Arguments : none
6974
6975 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6976 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6977 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6978 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6979 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6980 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6981 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006982 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006983 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6984 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006986 Examples :
6987 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6988 mode http
6989 option httplog
6990 option logasap
6991 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6992
6993 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6994 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6995 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6996 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006998 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006999 logging.
7000
7001
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007002option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007003 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7005 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007006 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007007 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7008 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007009 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007010
7011 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7012 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007013 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007014 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7015 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7016 in the MySQL table, like this :
7017
7018 USE mysql;
7019 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7020 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7021
7022 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007023 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007024 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7025 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7026 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7027 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7028 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7029 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7030 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7031
7032 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7033 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007034
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007035 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007036
7037 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7038 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7039 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7040 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007041 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7042 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007043
7044 See also: "option httpchk"
7045
7046
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007047option nolinger
7048no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007049 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007052 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007053
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007054 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007055 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7056 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7057 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7058 connections.
7059
7060 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7061 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7062 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7063 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7064 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7065 this too.
7066
7067 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7068 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7069 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7070
7071 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7072 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7073 for servers.
7074
7075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7077
7078
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007079option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7080 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7082 yes | yes | yes | yes
7083 Arguments :
7084 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7085 matching <network>
7086 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7087 header name.
7088
7089 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7090 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7091 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7092 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7093 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7094 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7095 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7096 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7097 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7098 possible that the client has already brought one.
7099
7100 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7101 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7102 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7103 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7104 header and requires different one.
7105
7106 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7107 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7108 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7109 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7110 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7111 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7112 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7113
7114 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7115 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7116 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7117 both are defined.
7118
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007119 Examples :
7120 # Original Destination address
7121 frontend www
7122 mode http
7123 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7124
7125 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7126 backend www
7127 mode http
7128 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7129
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007130 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007131
7132
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007133option persist
7134no option persist
7135 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007138 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007139
7140 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7141 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7142 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7143 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7144 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7145 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7146 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7147 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7148 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7149 redirected to another valid server.
7150
7151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7153
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007154 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007155
7156
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007157option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7158 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 yes | no | yes | yes
7161 Arguments :
7162 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7163 PostgreSQL server.
7164
7165 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7166 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7167 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7168 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7169
7170 See also: "option httpchk"
7171
7172
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007173option prefer-last-server
7174no option prefer-last-server
7175 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 yes | no | yes | yes
7178 Arguments : none
7179
7180 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7181 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7182 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7183 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7184 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7185 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7186 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7187 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7188 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007189 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7190 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007191 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7192 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7193 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007194 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7195 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7196 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007197
7198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7200
7201 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7202
7203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007204option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007205option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007206no option redispatch
7207 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7209 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007210 Arguments :
7211 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7212 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7213 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007214 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007215 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007216 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007217 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7218 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7219 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007221
7222 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7223 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7224 be able to access the service anymore.
7225
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007226 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7227 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007228
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007229 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007230 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7231 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007233 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7234 "redisp" keywords.
7235
7236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7238
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007239 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007240
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007241
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007242option redis-check
7243 Use redis health checks for server testing
7244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7245 yes | no | yes | yes
7246 Arguments : none
7247
7248 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7249 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7250 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7251 find the "+PONG" response message.
7252
7253 Example :
7254 option redis-check
7255
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007256 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007257
7258
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007259option smtpchk
7260option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7261 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7263 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007264 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007265 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007266 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007267 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7268
7269 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7270 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7271 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7272
7273 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7274 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7275 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7276 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7277 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7278 dead server.
7279
7280 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7281 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007282 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007283 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7284
7285 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7286 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7287 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7288 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007289 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007290
7291 Example :
7292 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7293
7294 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007297option socket-stats
7298no option socket-stats
7299
7300 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | yes | yes | no
7303
7304 Arguments : none
7305
7306
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007307option splice-auto
7308no option splice-auto
7309 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7311 yes | yes | yes | yes
7312 Arguments : none
7313
7314 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7315 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007316 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007317 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007318 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007319 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7320 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7321 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7322 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7323
7324 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7325 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7326 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7327 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7328 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7329 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7330 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7331 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7332 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7333 keyword.
7334
7335 Example :
7336 option splice-auto
7337
7338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7340
7341 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7342 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7343
7344
7345option splice-request
7346no option splice-request
7347 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7349 yes | yes | yes | yes
7350 Arguments : none
7351
7352 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007353 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007354 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7355 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7356 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7357 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7358
7359 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7360
7361 Example :
7362 option splice-request
7363
7364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7366
7367 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7368 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7369
7370
7371option splice-response
7372no option splice-response
7373 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | yes | yes | yes
7376 Arguments : none
7377
7378 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007379 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007380 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7381 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7382 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7383 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7384
7385 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7386
7387 Example :
7388 option splice-response
7389
7390 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7391 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7392
7393 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7394 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7395
7396
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007397option spop-check
7398 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 no | no | no | yes
7401 Arguments : none
7402
7403 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7404 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7405 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7406 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7407
7408 Example :
7409 option spop-check
7410
7411 See also : "option httpchk"
7412
7413
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007414option srvtcpka
7415no option srvtcpka
7416 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | no | yes | yes
7419 Arguments : none
7420
7421 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7422 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007423 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007424 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7425
7426 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7427 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7428 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7429 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7430
7431 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7432 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7433 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7434 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7435 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7436
7437 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7438
7439 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7440 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7441 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7442
7443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7445
7446 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7447
7448
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007449option ssl-hello-chk
7450 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7452 yes | no | yes | yes
7453 Arguments : none
7454
7455 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7456 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7457 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7458 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7459 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7460 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7461 hello message.
7462
7463 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7464 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7465 messages, which is appreciable.
7466
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007467 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7468 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7469 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007470
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007471 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7472
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007473
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007474option tcp-check
7475 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | no | yes | yes
7478
7479 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7480 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7481
7482 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7483 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7484 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007486 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007487 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7488 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7489 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7490 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7491 only.
7492
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007493 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007494 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7495 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7496 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7497 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7498
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007499 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007500 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7501 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007502 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007503 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7504 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7505 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7506 the respective protocols.
7507 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007508 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007509
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007510 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7511 script.
7512
7513 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7514 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7515 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7516 The "comment" is of course optional.
7517
7518
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007519 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007520 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007521 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007522 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007523
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007524 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007525 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007526 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007527
7528 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7529 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007530 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007531 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007532 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007533 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007534 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007535 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007536 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7537 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007538 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007539 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7540 tcp-check expect string +OK
7541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007542 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007543 (send many headers before analyzing)
7544 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007545 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007546 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7547 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7548 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7549 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007550 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007551
7552
7553 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7554
7555
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007556option tcp-smart-accept
7557no option tcp-smart-accept
7558 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7560 yes | yes | yes | no
7561 Arguments : none
7562
7563 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7564 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7565 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7566 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7567 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7568 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7569
7570 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7571 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7572 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7573 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7574
7575 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7576 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7577 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007578 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007579
7580 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7581 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7582 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7583
7584 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7585 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7586 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7587
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007588 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7589
7590
7591option tcp-smart-connect
7592no option tcp-smart-connect
7593 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7595 yes | no | yes | yes
7596 Arguments : none
7597
7598 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7599 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7600 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7601 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7602 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7603
7604 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7605 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7606 complex.
7607
7608 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7609 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7610 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7611
7612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7614
7615 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7616
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007617
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007618option tcpka
7619 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | yes | yes | yes
7622 Arguments : none
7623
7624 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7625 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007626 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007627 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7628
7629 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7630 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7631 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7632 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7633
7634 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7635 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7636 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7637 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7638 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7639
7640 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7641
7642 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7643 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7644 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7645 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7646 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7647 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7648 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7649 backends.
7650
7651 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7652
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007653
7654option tcplog
7655 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007657 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007658 Arguments : none
7659
7660 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7661 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7662 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7663 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7664 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7665 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7666 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7667 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7668
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007669 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007671 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007672
7673
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007674option transparent
7675no option transparent
7676 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007678 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007679 Arguments : none
7680
7681 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7682 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7683 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7684 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7685 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7686 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7687 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7688 appropriate server.
7689
7690 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7691 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7692
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007693 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007694 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007695
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007696
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007697external-check command <command>
7698 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7700 yes | no | yes | yes
7701
7702 Arguments :
7703 <command> is the external command to run
7704
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007705 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7706
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007707 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007708
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007709 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7710 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7711 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7712 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7713 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7714 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007715
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007716 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7717
7718 Environment variables :
7719 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7720 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7721
7722 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7723
7724 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7725
7726 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7727 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7728 for a UNIX socket).
7729
7730 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7731
7732 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7733
7734 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7735
7736 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7737
7738 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7739
7740 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7741 socket).
7742
7743 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7744 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7745
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007746 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7747
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007748 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7749 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7750 failed.
7751
7752 Example :
7753 external-check command /bin/true
7754
7755 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7756
7757
7758external-check path <path>
7759 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 yes | no | yes | yes
7762
7763 Arguments :
7764 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7765
7766 The default path is "".
7767
7768 Example :
7769 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7770
7771 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7772 "external-check command"
7773
7774
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007775persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007776persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007777 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 yes | no | yes | yes
7780 Arguments :
7781 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007782 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7783 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007784
7785 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7786 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007787 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007788 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7789 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7790 forwarded to this server.
7791
7792 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7793 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7794 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007795 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007796 a single "listen" section.
7797
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007798 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7799 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7800 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7801
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007802 Example :
7803 listen tse-farm
7804 bind :3389
7805 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7806 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7807 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7808 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7809 persist rdp-cookie
7810 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007811 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007812 balance rdp-cookie
7813 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7814 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7815
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007816 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7817 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007818
7819
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007820rate-limit sessions <rate>
7821 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | no
7824 Arguments :
7825 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7826 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7827
7828 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7829 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7830 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7831 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7832 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7833 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7834
7835 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7836 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7837 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7838 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7839
7840 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7841 listen smtp
7842 mode tcp
7843 bind :25
7844 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007845 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007846
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007847 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7848 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7849 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007850
7851 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7852
7853
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007854redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7855redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7856redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007857 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 no | yes | yes | yes
7860
7861 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007862 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007863
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007865 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007866 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7867 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7868 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007869
7870 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7871 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7872 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7873 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7874 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007875 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7876 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7877 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7878 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007879
7880 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7881 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7882 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7883 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7884 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7885 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007886 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007887 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007888 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7889 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7890 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007891
7892 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007893 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7894 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7895 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007896 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007897 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7898 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7899 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7900 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007901
7902 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007903 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007904
7905 - "drop-query"
7906 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7907 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7908 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7909 with a location-type redirect.
7910
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007911 - "append-slash"
7912 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7913 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7914 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7915 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7916
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007917 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7918 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7919 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7920 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7921 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7922 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7923 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7924
7925 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7926 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7927 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7928 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7929 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7930 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7931 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007932
7933 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7934 acl clear dst_port 80
7935 acl secure dst_port 8080
7936 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007937 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007938 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007939 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7940
7941 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007942 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7943 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7944 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007945 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007946
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007947 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7948 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7949 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7950
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007951 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007952 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007953
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007954 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007955 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7956 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7957 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007959 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007960
7961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007962redisp (deprecated)
7963redispatch (deprecated)
7964 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7966 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007967 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007968
7969 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7970 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7971 be able to access the service anymore.
7972
7973 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7974 redistribute them to a working server.
7975
7976 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7977 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7978 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007980 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7981 "option redispatch" instead.
7982
7983 See also : "option redispatch"
7984
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007985
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007986reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007987 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 no | yes | yes | yes
7990 Arguments :
7991 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7992 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007993 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007994
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007995 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7996 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7997
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007998 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7999 the last header of an HTTP request.
8000
8001 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8002 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8003 responses.
8004
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008005 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8006 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8007 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8008
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008009 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8010 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008011
8012
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008013reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8014reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008015 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 no | yes | yes | yes
8018 Arguments :
8019 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8020 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8021 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8022 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8023 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8024 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8025 ignores case.
8026
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008027 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8028 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008030 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8031 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8032 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8033 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008034 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008035
8036 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8037 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8038
8039 Example :
8040 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8041 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8042 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8043
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008044 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8045 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008046
8047
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008048reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8049reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008050 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8052 no | yes | yes | yes
8053 Arguments :
8054 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8055 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8056 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8057 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8058 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8059 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8060
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008061 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8062 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8063
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008064 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8065 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8066 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8067 next servers.
8068
8069 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8070 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8071 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8072
8073 Example :
8074 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8075 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8076 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8077
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008078 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8079 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008080
8081
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008082reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8083reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008084 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 no | yes | yes | yes
8087 Arguments :
8088 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8089 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8090 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8091 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8092 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8093 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8094 case.
8095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008096 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8097 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8098
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008099 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8100 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8101 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8102 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008103 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008104
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008105 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008106 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008107 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008109 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8110 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8111
8112 Example :
8113 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8114 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8115 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8116
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008117 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8118 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008119
8120
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008121reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8122reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008123 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 no | yes | yes | yes
8126 Arguments :
8127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8128 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8129 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8130 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8131 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8132 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8133 case.
8134
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008138 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8139 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8140 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8141 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8142
8143 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8144 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8145
8146 Example :
8147 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8148 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8149 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8150 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8151
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008152 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8153 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008154
8155
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008156reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8157reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008158 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 no | yes | yes | yes
8161 Arguments :
8162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8163 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8164 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8165 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8166 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8167 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8168
8169 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8170 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8171 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8172 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008173 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008174
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008175 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8176 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008178 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8179 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8180 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8181
8182 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8183 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8184 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8185 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8186 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8187
8188 Example :
8189 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008190 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008191 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8192 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8193
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008194 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8195 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008196
8197
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008198reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8199reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008200 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8202 no | yes | yes | yes
8203 Arguments :
8204 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8205 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8206 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8207 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8208 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8209 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8210 ignores case.
8211
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008212 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8213 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8214
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008215 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8216 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008217 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8218 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8219 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008220 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8221 not set.
8222
8223 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8224 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8225 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8226 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8227 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008229 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008231 # block all others.
8232 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8233 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008235 # block bad guys
8236 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8237 reqitarpit . if badguys
8238
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008239 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8240 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008241
8242
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008243retries <value>
8244 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8246 yes | no | yes | yes
8247 Arguments :
8248 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8249 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8250 default value is 3.
8251
8252 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8253 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8254 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8255
8256 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008257 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8258 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008259
8260 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8261 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8262
8263 See also : "option redispatch"
8264
8265
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008266retry-on [list of keywords]
8267 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 yes | no | yes | yes
8270 Arguments :
8271 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8272 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8273 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8274 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8275
8276 none never retry
8277
8278 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8279 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8280
8281 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8282 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8283 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8284 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8285 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8286 processing the request.
8287
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008288 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8289 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8290 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8291 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8292 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8293 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8294 overflow attack for example).
8295
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008296 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8297 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8298 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8299 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8300 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8301 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8302 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8303 amplify denial of service attacks.
8304
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008305 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8306 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8307 considered to be safe to retry.
8308
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008309 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8310 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8311 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8312 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8313
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008314 all-retryable-errors
8315 retry request for any error that are considered
8316 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8317 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8318 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8319
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008320 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8321 not cumulative.
8322
8323 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8324 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8325 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8326 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8327
8328 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8329 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8330 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8331 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8332 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8333 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8334 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8335 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8336 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8337 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8338 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8339 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8340
8341 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8342 should not use this directive.
8343
8344 The default is "conn-failure".
8345
8346 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8347
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008348rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008349 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 no | yes | yes | yes
8352 Arguments :
8353 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8354 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008355 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008356
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008357 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8358 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8359
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008360 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8361 the last header of an HTTP response.
8362
8363 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8364 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8365 responses.
8366
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008367 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8368 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008369
8370
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008371rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8372rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008373 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 no | yes | yes | yes
8376 Arguments :
8377 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8378 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8379 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8380 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8381 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8382 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8383 ignores case.
8384
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008385 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8386 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8387
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008388 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8389 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008390 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008391 client.
8392
8393 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8394 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8395 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8396
8397 Example :
8398 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008399 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008400
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008401 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8402 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008403
8404
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008405rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8406rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008407 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8409 no | yes | yes | yes
8410 Arguments :
8411 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8412 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8413 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8414 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8415 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8416 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8417 ignores case.
8418
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008419 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8420 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8421
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008422 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8423 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8424 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8425 case-sensitive.
8426
8427 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008428 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8429 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8430 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008431
8432 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8433 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8434
8435 Example :
8436 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8437 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8438
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008439 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8440 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008441
8442
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008443rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8444rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008445 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 no | yes | yes | yes
8448 Arguments :
8449 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8450 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8451 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8452 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8453 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8454 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8455 ignores case.
8456
8457 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8458 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8459 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8460 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008461 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008462
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008463 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8464 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8465
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008466 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8467 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8468 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8469
8470 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8471 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8472 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8473 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8474 are not case-sensitive.
8475
8476 Example :
8477 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8478 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8479
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008480 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8481 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008482
8483
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008484server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008485 Declare a server in a backend
8486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8487 no | no | yes | yes
8488 Arguments :
8489 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008490 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008491 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008492
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008493 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8494 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8495 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8496 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008497 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8498 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8499 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8500 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8501 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008502 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8503 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8504 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8505 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8506 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8507 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8508 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008509 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008510 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8511 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8512 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8513 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8514 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8515 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008516 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8517 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008518 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8519 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008520
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008521 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008522 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8523 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8524 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8525 adding this value to the client's port.
8526
8527 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8528 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008529 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008530
8531 Examples :
8532 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8533 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008534 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008535 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8536 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8537 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008539 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8540 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8541 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8542 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8543 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8544
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008545 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8546 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008547
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008548server-state-file-name [<file>]
8549 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8550 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8551 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8552 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8553 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8554 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8555
8556 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8557 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8558
8559 global
8560 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8561
8562 backend bk
8563 load-server-state-from-file
8564
8565 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8566 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008567
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008568server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8569 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8570 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8572 no | no | yes | yes
8573
8574 Arguments:
8575 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8576
8577 <num | range>
8578 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8579 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8580 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8581 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8582
8583 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8584
8585 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8586
8587 <params*>
8588 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8589 keyword.
8590
8591 Examples:
8592 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8593 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8594 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8595
8596 # or
8597 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8598
8599 # would be equivalent to:
8600 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8601 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8602 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8603
8604
8605
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008606source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008607source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008608source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008609 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8611 yes | no | yes | yes
8612 Arguments :
8613 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8614 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008615
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008616 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008617 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8618 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8619 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8620 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8621 supported prefixes are :
8622 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8623 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8624 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008625 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008626 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8627 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628
8629 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8630 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008631 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8632 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8633 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008634
8635 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8636 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8637 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8638 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8639 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8640 <addr>.
8641
8642 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8643 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8644 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8645 port.
8646
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008647 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8648 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8649 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8650 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008651 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008652 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8653 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8654 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8655 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8656 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8657 HTTP header.
8658
8659 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8660 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008661 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008662 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8663 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8664 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8665 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8666 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8667 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8668 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8669
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008670 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8671 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8672 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8673 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8674 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8675 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8676
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008677 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8678 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8679 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8680 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8681
8682 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8683 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8684 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8685 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8686 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8687 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8688
8689 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8690 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8691 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8692 there are two methods :
8693
8694 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8695 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8696 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8697 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8698 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8699 of the client ranges may be used.
8700
8701 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8702 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8703 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8704 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8705 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8706 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8707 same session.
8708
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008709 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8710 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8711 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008712 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008713
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008714 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8715
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008716 Examples :
8717 backend private
8718 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8719 source 192.168.1.200
8720
8721 backend transparent_ssl1
8722 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8723 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8724
8725 backend transparent_ssl2
8726 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8727 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8728 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8729
8730 backend transparent_ssl3
8731 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8732 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8733 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8734
8735 backend transparent_smtp
8736 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8737 # with Tproxy version 4.
8738 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8739
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008740 backend transparent_http
8741 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8742 # proxy.
8743 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008745 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008746 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008748
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008749srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8750 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8752 yes | no | yes | yes
8753 Arguments :
8754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8756 as explained at the top of this document.
8757
8758 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8759 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8760 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8761 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8762 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8763 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8764 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8765
8766 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8767 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8768 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8769 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8770 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008771 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008772 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008774
8775 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8776 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8777 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8778 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8779 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8780 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8781
8782 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8783 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8784
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008785 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8786 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008787
8788
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008789stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8790 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008792 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008793
8794 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8795 matched.
8796
8797 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8798 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8799
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008800 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8801 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008802 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008803
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008804 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8805 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8806 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8807 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008808
8809 Example :
8810 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8811 backend stats_localhost
8812 stats enable
8813 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8814
8815 Example :
8816 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8817 backend stats_auth
8818 stats enable
8819 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8820 stats admin if TRUE
8821
8822 Example :
8823 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8824 userlist stats-auth
8825 group admin users admin
8826 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8827 group readonly users haproxy
8828 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8829
8830 backend stats_auth
8831 stats enable
8832 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8833 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8834 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8835 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8836
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008837 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8838 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8839 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008840
8841
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008842stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8843 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008845 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008846 Arguments :
8847 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8848
8849 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8850
8851 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8852 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8853 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8854 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8855 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8856 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8857
8858 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8859 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8860 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008861 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008862
8863 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8864 report using "stats scope".
8865
8866 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8867 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8868 unobvious parameters.
8869
8870 Example :
8871 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8872 backend public_www
8873 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8874 stats enable
8875 stats hide-version
8876 stats scope .
8877 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008878 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008879 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8880 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8881
8882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8883 backend private_monitoring
8884 stats enable
8885 stats uri /admin?stats
8886 stats refresh 5s
8887
8888 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8889
8890
8891stats enable
8892 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008894 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008895 Arguments : none
8896
8897 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8898 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8899 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8900 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8901 - stats auth : no authentication
8902 - stats scope : no restriction
8903
8904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8906 unobvious parameters.
8907
8908 Example :
8909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8910 backend public_www
8911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8912 stats enable
8913 stats hide-version
8914 stats scope .
8915 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008916 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8919
8920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8921 backend private_monitoring
8922 stats enable
8923 stats uri /admin?stats
8924 stats refresh 5s
8925
8926 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8927
8928
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008929stats hide-version
8930 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008933 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008935 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8936 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8937 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8938 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8939 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8940 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8944 unobvious parameters.
8945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008946 Example :
8947 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8948 backend public_www
8949 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008950 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008951 stats hide-version
8952 stats scope .
8953 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8956 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008957
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8959 backend private_monitoring
8960 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008961 stats uri /admin?stats
8962 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008964 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008965
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008966
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008967stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8968 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8969 Access control for statistics
8970
8971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8972 no | no | yes | yes
8973
8974 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8975 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8976 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8977 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8978 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8979 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8980
8981 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8982 instance.
8983
8984 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8985 about ACL usage.
8986
8987
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008988stats realm <realm>
8989 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008992 Arguments :
8993 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8994 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8995 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8996
8997 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8998 using a backslash ('\').
8999
9000 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9001 only related to authentication.
9002
9003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9005 unobvious parameters.
9006
9007 Example :
9008 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9009 backend public_www
9010 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9011 stats enable
9012 stats hide-version
9013 stats scope .
9014 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009016 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9017 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9018
9019 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9020 backend private_monitoring
9021 stats enable
9022 stats uri /admin?stats
9023 stats refresh 5s
9024
9025 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9026
9027
9028stats refresh <delay>
9029 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009031 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009032 Arguments :
9033 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9034 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9035 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9036 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9037 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9038 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9039
9040 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9041 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9042 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9043 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9044
9045 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9046 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9047 unobvious parameters.
9048
9049 Example :
9050 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9051 backend public_www
9052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9053 stats enable
9054 stats hide-version
9055 stats scope .
9056 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009058 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9059 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9060
9061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9062 backend private_monitoring
9063 stats enable
9064 stats uri /admin?stats
9065 stats refresh 5s
9066
9067 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9068
9069
9070stats scope { <name> | "." }
9071 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009073 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009074 Arguments :
9075 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9076 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9077 section in which the statement appears.
9078
9079 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9080 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9081 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9082 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9083 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9084 exists.
9085
9086 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9087 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9088 unobvious parameters.
9089
9090 Example :
9091 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9092 backend public_www
9093 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9094 stats enable
9095 stats hide-version
9096 stats scope .
9097 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009098 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009099 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9100 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9101
9102 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9103 backend private_monitoring
9104 stats enable
9105 stats uri /admin?stats
9106 stats refresh 5s
9107
9108 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9109
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009110
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009111stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009112 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009115
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009116 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009117 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9118
9119 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9120 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9121
9122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009124 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009125
9126 Example :
9127 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9128 backend private_monitoring
9129 stats enable
9130 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9131 stats uri /admin?stats
9132 stats refresh 5s
9133
9134 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9135 global section.
9136
9137
9138stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009139 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9141 yes | yes | yes | yes
9142 Arguments : none
9143
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009144 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009145 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9146 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9147 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9148 - IP (socket, server)
9149 - cookie (backend, server)
9150
9151 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9152 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009153 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009154
9155 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9156
9157
9158stats show-node [ <name> ]
9159 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009161 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009162 Arguments:
9163 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9164 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9165
9166 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9167 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009168 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009169
9170 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9171 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9172 unobvious parameters.
9173
9174 Example:
9175 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9176 backend private_monitoring
9177 stats enable
9178 stats show-node Europe-1
9179 stats uri /admin?stats
9180 stats refresh 5s
9181
9182 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9183 section.
9184
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009185
9186stats uri <prefix>
9187 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009189 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009190 Arguments :
9191 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9192 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9193 query string.
9194
9195 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9196 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9197 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9198 possible to reach it in the application.
9199
9200 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009201 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009202 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9203 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9204 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9205 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9206
9207 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9208 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9209 an address or a port to statistics only.
9210
9211 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9212 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9213 unobvious parameters.
9214
9215 Example :
9216 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9217 backend public_www
9218 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9219 stats enable
9220 stats hide-version
9221 stats scope .
9222 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009224 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9225 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9226
9227 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9228 backend private_monitoring
9229 stats enable
9230 stats uri /admin?stats
9231 stats refresh 5s
9232
9233 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9234
9235
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009236stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9237 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009239 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009240
9241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009242 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009243 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009245 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9246
9247 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9248 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9249 the "stick-table" statement.
9250
9251 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9252 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9253 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9254 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9255 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9256
9257 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9258 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9259 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9260 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9261 transformation rules.
9262
9263 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9264 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9265 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9266 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9267 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9268 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9269 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9270
9271 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9272 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9273 ACL based conditions.
9274
9275 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9276 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9277 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9278 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9279
9280 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9281 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9282 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9283 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9284
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009285 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9286 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009287 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009288
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009289 Example :
9290 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9291 # last 30 minutes
9292 backend pop
9293 mode tcp
9294 balance roundrobin
9295 stick store-request src
9296 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9297 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9298 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9299
9300 backend smtp
9301 mode tcp
9302 balance roundrobin
9303 stick match src table pop
9304 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9305 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9306
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009307 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009308 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009309
9310
9311stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9312 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 no | no | yes | yes
9315
9316 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9317 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9318 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9319 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9320
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009321 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9322 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009323 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009324
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009325 Examples :
9326 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009327 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009328
9329 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9330 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9331 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9332
9333
9334 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9335 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9336 backend http
9337 mode http
9338 balance roundrobin
9339 stick on src table https
9340 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9341 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9342 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9343
9344 backend https
9345 mode tcp
9346 balance roundrobin
9347 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9348 stick on src
9349 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9350 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009352 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009353
9354
9355stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9356 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9358 no | no | yes | yes
9359
9360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009361 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009362 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009363 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009364 server is selected.
9365
9366 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9367 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9368 the "stick-table" statement.
9369
9370 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9371 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9372 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9373 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9374 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9375 address.
9376
9377 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9378 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9379 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9380 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9381 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9382 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9383 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9384 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9385 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9386 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9387
9388 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9389 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9390 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9391 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9392 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9393 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9394 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9395
9396 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9397 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9398 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9399 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9400
9401 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9402 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9403 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9404 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9405 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9406 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009407 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9408 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9409 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9410 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9411 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9412 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009413
9414 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9415 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9416 the request.
9417
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009418 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9419 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009420 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009421
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009422 Example :
9423 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9424 # last 30 minutes
9425 backend pop
9426 mode tcp
9427 balance roundrobin
9428 stick store-request src
9429 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9430 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9431 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9432
9433 backend smtp
9434 mode tcp
9435 balance roundrobin
9436 stick match src table pop
9437 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9438 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9439
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009440 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009441 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009442
9443
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009444stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009445 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9446 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009447 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009449 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009450
9451 Arguments :
9452 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9453 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9454 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9455 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9456
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009457 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9458 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9459 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9460 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9461
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009462 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9463 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9464 instance.
9465
9466 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9467 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9468 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9469 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9470 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9471 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009472 to 32 characters.
9473
9474 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9475 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9476 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009477 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009478 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9479 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009480
9481 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009482 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9483 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009484 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9485 increase.
9486
9487 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009488 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9489 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9490 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009491
9492 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9493 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9494 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9495 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009496 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009497 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9498 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9499 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9500 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9501 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9502 parameter (see below).
9503
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009504 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9505 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9506 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9507 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9508 soft restart.
9509
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009510 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9511 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009512
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009513 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9514 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9515 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9516 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009517 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009518 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009519 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9520 if not expiration delay is specified.
9521
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009522 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9523 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9524 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9525 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009526 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9527 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9528 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9529 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9530 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9531 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9532 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9533 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9534 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9535 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9536 types and their arguments.
9537
9538 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9539 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9540 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9541 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9542
9543 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9544 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9545 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009546 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009547
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009548 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9549 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9550 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009551 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009552 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009553 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009554
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009555 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9556 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9557 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9558 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9559
9560 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9561 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9562 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9563 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9564 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9565 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9566
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009567 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9568 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9569 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9570 they were received.
9571
9572 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9573 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9574 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9575 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9576 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9577
9578 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9579 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9580 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9581 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9582 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9583
9584 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9585 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9586 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9587
9588 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9589 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9590 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9591 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9592 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9593
9594 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9595 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9596 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9597 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9598 the client side.
9599
9600 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9601 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9602 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9603 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9604 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9605 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9606 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9607
9608 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9609 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9610 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9611 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9612 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9613 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009614 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009615
9616 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9617 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9618 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9619 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9620 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9621 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9622
9623 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009624 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009625 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9626 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9627
9628 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9629 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9630 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9631 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9632 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9633 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9634 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9635 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9636 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9637 recommended for better fairness.
9638
9639 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009640 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009641 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9642 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9643
9644 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9645 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9646 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9647 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9648 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9649 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9650 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9651 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9652 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9653 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009654
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009655 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9656 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009657 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9658 reference it.
9659
9660 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9661 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009662 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9663 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9664 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009665
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009666 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9667 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9668 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9669 something that can be ignored.
9670
9671 Example:
9672 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9673 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9674 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9675 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9676
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009677 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009678 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009679
9680
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009681stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009682 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 no | no | yes | yes
9685
9686 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009687 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009688 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009689 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009690 server is selected.
9691
9692 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9693 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9694 the "stick-table" statement.
9695
9696 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9697 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9698 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9699 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9700
9701 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9702 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9703 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9704 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9705 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9706 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009707 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009708 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9709 rules.
9710
9711 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9712 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9713 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9714 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9715 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9716 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9717 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9718
9719 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9720 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9721 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9722 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9723
9724 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9725 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9726 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9727 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9728 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9729 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009730 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9731 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9732 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9733 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9734 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9735 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9736 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9737 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9738 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009739
9740 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9741
9742 Example :
9743 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9744 backend https
9745 mode tcp
9746 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009747 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009748 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009749
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009750 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9751 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9752
9753 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9754 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9755 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9756
9757 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9758 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009759
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9761 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9762 # at offset 44.
9763
9764 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9765 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9766
9767 # Learn on response if server hello.
9768 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009769
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009770 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9771 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9772
9773 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9774 extraction.
9775
9776
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009777tcp-check connect [params*]
9778 Opens a new connection
9779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9780 no | no | yes | yes
9781
9782 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9783 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9784 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9785
9786 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9787 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9788 of the sequence.
9789
9790 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9791 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9792 do.
9793
9794 Parameters :
9795 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9796 use the TCP connection.
9797
9798 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9799 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9800 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9801
9802 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9803
9804 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9805
9806 Examples:
9807 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9808 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9809 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9810 option tcp-check
9811 tcp-check connect
9812 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9813 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9814 tcp-check send \r\n
9815 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9816 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9817 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9818 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9819 tcp-check send \r\n
9820 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9821 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9822
9823 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9824 option tcp-check
9825 tcp-check connect port 110
9826 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9827 tcp-check connect port 143
9828 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9829 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9830
9831 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9832
9833
9834tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009836 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 no | no | yes | yes
9838
9839 Arguments :
9840 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9841 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9842 binary.
9843 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9844 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9845 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9846
9847 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9848 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9849 with the usual backslash ('\').
9850 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009851 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009852 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9853 used upper or lower case.
9854
9855
9856 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9857
9858 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9859 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9860 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9861 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9862 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9863 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9864 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9865 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9866
9867 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9868 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9869 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9870 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9871 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9872 expression.
9873
9874 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9875 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9876 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9877 this exact hexadecimal string.
9878 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9879
9880 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9881 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9882 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9883 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9884 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9885 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9886 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9887 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9888 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9889 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9890 the null character.
9891
9892 Examples :
9893 # perform a POP check
9894 option tcp-check
9895 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9896
9897 # perform an IMAP check
9898 option tcp-check
9899 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9900
9901 # look for the redis master server
9902 option tcp-check
9903 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009904 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009905 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9906 tcp-check expect string role:master
9907 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9908 tcp-check expect string +OK
9909
9910
9911 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9912 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9913
9914
9915tcp-check send <data>
9916 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9918 no | no | yes | yes
9919
9920 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9921 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9922
9923 Examples :
9924 # look for the redis master server
9925 option tcp-check
9926 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9927 tcp-check expect string role:master
9928
9929 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9930 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9931
9932
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009933tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9934 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009935 tcp health check
9936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9937 no | no | yes | yes
9938
9939 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9940 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009941 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009942 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9943 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9944 hexadecimal string.
9945 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9946
9947 Examples :
9948 # redis check in binary
9949 option tcp-check
9950 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9951 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9952
9953
9954 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9955 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9956
9957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009958tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9959 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9961 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009962 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009963 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9964 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009966 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009967
9968 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9969 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9971 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9972 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9973 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9974 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9975 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009977 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9978 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9979 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9980 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009981
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009982 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009983 - accept :
9984 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9985 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9986 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009988 - reject :
9989 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9990 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9991 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9992 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9993 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9994 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9995 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9996 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9997 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9998 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9999 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010000 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010001
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010002 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10003 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10004 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10005 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10006 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10007 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10008 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10009 hosts.
10010
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010011 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10012 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10013 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10014 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10015 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10016 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10017 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10018 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10019
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010020 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10021 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10022 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10023 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10024 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10025 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10026 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10027 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10028 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010029 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10030 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010031
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010032 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010033 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010034 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10035 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10036 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010037 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010038 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10039 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10040 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10041 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10042 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10043 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10044 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10045 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010047 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010048 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010049 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010050 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010051 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10052 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10053 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010055 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10056 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10057 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10058 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010060 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10061 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10062 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10063 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10064 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010065 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10066 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10067 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10068 layer7 information is extracted.
10069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010070 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10071 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10072 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10073 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10074 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010075
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010076 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10077 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10078 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10079 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10080
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010081 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10082 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10083 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10084 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10085
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010086 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10087 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10088 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10089 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10090 continues.
10091
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010092 - set-src <expr> :
10093 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10094 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10095 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010096 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010098 Arguments:
10099 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10100 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010101
10102 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010103 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10104
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010105 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10106 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010107
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010108 - set-src-port <expr> :
10109 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10110 expression.
10111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010112 Arguments:
10113 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10114 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010115
10116 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010117 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10118
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010119 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10120 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10121 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010122
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010123 - set-dst <expr> :
10124 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10125 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10126 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10127 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10128 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10129
10130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10131 followed by some converters.
10132
10133 Example:
10134
10135 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10136 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10137
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010138 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10139 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10140
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010141 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10142 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10143 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10144 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10145
10146
10147 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10148 followed by some converters.
10149
10150 Example:
10151
10152 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10153
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010154 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10155 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10156 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10157
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010158 - "silent-drop" :
10159 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010161 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10162 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10163 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10164 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10165 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010166 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10167 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010168 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10169 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010170 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010171 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10172 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10173 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10174 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010176 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10177 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10178 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010180 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10181 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10182 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010184 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010185 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010186 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010188 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10189 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10190 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010192 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010193 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10194 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010195
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010196 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10197
10198 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10199
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010200 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10201
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010202 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010203
10204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10206 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010208 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010210 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10211 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010213 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010214
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010215 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010216 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10217 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10218 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10219 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010221 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10222 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10223 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10224 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010225 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10226 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10227 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10228 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10229 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10230 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010231 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010232 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010234 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10235 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10236 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10237 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010238
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010239 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010240 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010241 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010242 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10243 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010244 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010245 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010246 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010247 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010248 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010249 - set-dst <expr>
10250 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010251 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010252 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010253 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010254 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010255 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010257 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10258 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010259 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10260 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010261
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010262 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10263 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10264 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10265 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10266 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10267 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010269 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010270 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10271 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010273 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010274 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10275 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10276 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10277 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010278 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10279 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10280 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010281
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010282 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010283 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10284 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10285 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010286
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010287 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10288 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10289
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010290 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010291 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10292 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010293
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010294 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10295 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010296 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010297 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10298 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010299 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010300 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010301 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010302 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10303 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010304 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010305 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10306 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010307
10308 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10309 followed by some converters.
10310
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010311 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10312 <var-name>.
10313
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010314 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10315 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10316 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10317 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10318 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10319
10320 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10321 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10322 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10323 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10324 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10325 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10326 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10327 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10328 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10329 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10330 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10331
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010332 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10333 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10334 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10335 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10336 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10337
10338 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10339
10340 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10341
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010342 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10343 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10344 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10345 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10346 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10347 evaluated.
10348
10349 Example:
10350 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10351
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010352 Example:
10353
10354 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010355 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010356
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010357 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10359 # and reject everything else.
10360 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10361 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010362 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010363 tcp-request content reject
10364
10365 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010366 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10367 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10368 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010369 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010370
10371 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10372 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10373 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010374 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010375 tcp-request content reject
10376
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010377 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010378 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010379 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010380 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010381 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10382 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010383
10384 Example:
10385 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10386 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010387 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010389 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010390 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010391
10392 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010393 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010394 # protecting all our sites
10395 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010396 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10397 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010398 ...
10399 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10400
10401 backend http_dynamic
10402 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010403 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010404 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010405 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010406 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010407 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010408 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010410 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010411
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010412 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10413 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010414
10415
10416tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010419 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010420 Arguments :
10421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10423 as explained at the top of this document.
10424
10425 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10426 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10427 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10428 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10429 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10430
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010431 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10432 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10433 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10434 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10435
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010436 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10437 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010438 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010439 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010440 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10441 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10442 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10443 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010444
10445 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10446 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10447 it pass through unaffected.
10448
10449 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10450 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10451 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010452 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10454 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010455 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10456 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10457 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010458
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010459 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010460 "timeout client".
10461
10462
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010463tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10464 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10466 no | no | yes | yes
10467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010468 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10469 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010470
10471 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010473 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010474 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10475 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010476 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10477 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010478
10479 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10480
10481 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10482 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10483 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10484 inserted.
10485
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010486 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010487 - accept :
10488 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10489 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10490 the rules evaluation.
10491
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010492 - close :
10493 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10494 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10495 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10496 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10497 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10498 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010499 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010500 protocols.
10501
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010502 - reject :
10503 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10504 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010505 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010506
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010507 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10508 Sets a variable.
10509
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010510 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10511 Unsets a variable.
10512
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010513 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10514 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10516 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10517
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010518 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10519 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10520 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10521 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10522
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010523 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10524 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10525 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10526 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10527 continues.
10528
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010529 - "silent-drop" :
10530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010531 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010532 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10533 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10534 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10535 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10536 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010537 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10538 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010539 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10540 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010542 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10543 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10544 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10545 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10546
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010547 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10548 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10549
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010550 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10551 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10552 for changing the default action to a reject.
10553
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010554 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10555 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10556 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10557 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010558 period.
10559
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010560 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10561 declared inline.
10562
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010563 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10564 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010565 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010566 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10567 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010568 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010569 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010570 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010571 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10572 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010573 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010574 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10575 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010576
10577 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10578 followed by some converters.
10579
10580 Example:
10581
10582 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10583
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010584 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10585 <var-name>.
10586
10587 Example:
10588
10589 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10590
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010591 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10592 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10593 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10594 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10595 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10596
10597 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10598
10599 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10600
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010601 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10602
10603 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10604
10605
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010606tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10607 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 no | yes | yes | no
10610 Arguments :
10611 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10612 below.
10613
10614 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010616 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010617 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10618 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10619 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10620 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10621 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10622 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10623 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010624 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010625 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10626 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10627 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10628 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10629 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10630 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10631 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10632 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10633 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10634 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10635 instead.
10636
10637 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10638 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10639 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10640 rules which may be inserted.
10641
10642 Several types of actions are supported :
10643 - accept : the request is accepted
10644 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10645 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10646 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010647 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010648 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10649 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010650 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010651 - silent-drop
10652
10653 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10654 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10655 sections for a complete description.
10656
10657 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10658 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10659 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10660
10661 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10662 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10663 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10664 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10665 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10666
10667 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10668 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10669
10670 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10671 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10672 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10673
10674 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10675 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10676 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10677
10678 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10679 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10680 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10681
10682 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10683 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10684 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10685
10686 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10687
10688 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10689
10690
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010691tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10692 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10694 no | no | yes | yes
10695 Arguments :
10696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10698 as explained at the top of this document.
10699
10700 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10701
10702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010703timeout check <timeout>
10704 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10705 established.
10706
10707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10708 yes | no | yes | yes
10709 Arguments:
10710 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10711 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10712 as explained at the top of this document.
10713
10714 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10715 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010716 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010717 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010718 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10719 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10720 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010721
10722 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10723 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10724
10725 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10726 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010727 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010728
10729 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10730 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10731 forget about it.
10732
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010733 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10734 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010735
10736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010737timeout client <timeout>
10738timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10739 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10741 yes | yes | yes | no
10742 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010743 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10745 as explained at the top of this document.
10746
10747 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10748 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10749 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010750 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10751 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10752 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10753 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010754 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10755 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10756 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010757 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010758 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010759 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10760 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010761 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10762 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010763
10764 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10766 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10767 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010768 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010769 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10770
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010771 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010773 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10774 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10775 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10776
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010777 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10778 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010779
10780
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010781timeout client-fin <timeout>
10782 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10784 yes | yes | yes | no
10785 Arguments :
10786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10788 as explained at the top of this document.
10789
10790 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10791 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10792 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10793 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10794 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10795 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10796 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010797 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10798 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10799 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010800
10801 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10802 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10803 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10804
10805 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10806
10807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010808timeout connect <timeout>
10809timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10810 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 yes | no | yes | yes
10813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10816 as explained at the top of this document.
10817
10818 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010819 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010820 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010821 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010822 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10823 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010824
10825 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10827 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10828 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010829 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010830 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10831
10832 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10833 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10834 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10835
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010836 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10837 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010838
10839
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010840timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10841 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10843 yes | yes | yes | yes
10844 Arguments :
10845 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10846 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10847 as explained at the top of this document.
10848
10849 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10850 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10851 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10852 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10853 once the request has started to present itself.
10854
10855 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10856 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10857 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10858 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10859 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10860
10861 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10862 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10863 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10864 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10865
10866 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10867 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010868 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010869 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10870 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010871 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010872
10873 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10874 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10875 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10876 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10877
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010878 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10879 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010880 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10881
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010882 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10883
10884
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010885timeout http-request <timeout>
10886 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010890 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010891 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10892 as explained at the top of this document.
10893
10894 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10895 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10896 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10897 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10898 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10899 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10900 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010901 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10902 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10903 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10904 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010905 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010906 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10907 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010908
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010909 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10910 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10911 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10912 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10913 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010914 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010915
10916 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10917 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010919 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10920 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10921
10922 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010923 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10924 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10925 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010926
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010927 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010928 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010929
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010930
10931timeout queue <timeout>
10932 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10934 yes | no | yes | yes
10935 Arguments :
10936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10938 as explained at the top of this document.
10939
10940 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10941 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10942 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10943 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10944 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10945
10946 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10947 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10948 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10949 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10950
10951 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10952
10953
10954timeout server <timeout>
10955timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10956 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10958 yes | no | yes | yes
10959 Arguments :
10960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10962 as explained at the top of this document.
10963
10964 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10965 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10966 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10967 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10968 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10969 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10970 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10971
10972 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10973 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10974 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10975 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10976 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010977 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010978 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010979 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10980 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010981 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10982 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010983
10984 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10985 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10986 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10987 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010988 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010989 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10990
10991 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10992 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10993 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10994
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010995 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010996
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010997
10998timeout server-fin <timeout>
10999 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11001 yes | no | yes | yes
11002 Arguments :
11003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11005 as explained at the top of this document.
11006
11007 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11008 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11009 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11010 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11011 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11012 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11013 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11014 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11015 situations, it should not be needed.
11016
11017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11018 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11019 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11020
11021 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11022
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011023
11024timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011025 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11027 yes | yes | yes | yes
11028 Arguments :
11029 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11031 as explained at the top of this document.
11032
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011033 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11034 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11035 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11036 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011037
11038 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11039 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11040 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11041 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011042 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011043
11044 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11045
11046
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011047timeout tunnel <timeout>
11048 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11050 yes | no | yes | yes
11051 Arguments :
11052 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11054 as explained at the top of this document.
11055
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011056 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011057 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11058 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11059 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011060 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11061 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011062 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11063 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11064 specified.
11065
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011066 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11067 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11068 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11069 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11070 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11071 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11072 state.
11073
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011074 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11075 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11076 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11077 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011078 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011079
11080 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11081 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11082 forget about it.
11083
11084 Example :
11085 defaults http
11086 option http-server-close
11087 timeout connect 5s
11088 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011089 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011090 timeout server 30s
11091 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11092
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011093 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011094
11095
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011096transparent (deprecated)
11097 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011099 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011100 Arguments : none
11101
11102 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11103 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11104 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11105 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11106 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11107 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11108 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11109 appropriate server.
11110
11111 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11112
11113 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11114 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11115
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011116 See also: "option transparent"
11117
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011118unique-id-format <string>
11119 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11121 yes | yes | yes | no
11122 Arguments :
11123 <string> is a log-format string.
11124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011125 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11126 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11127 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11128 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011129
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011130 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11131 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11132 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11133 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11134 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11135 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11136 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11137 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011138
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011139 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11140 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011141
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011142 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011143
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011144 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011145
11146 will generate:
11147
11148 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11149
11150 See also: "unique-id-header"
11151
11152unique-id-header <name>
11153 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11155 yes | yes | yes | no
11156 Arguments :
11157 <name> is the name of the header.
11158
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011159 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11160 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011161
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011162 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011163
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011164 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011165 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11166
11167 will generate:
11168
11169 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11170
11171 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011172
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011173use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011174 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11176 no | yes | yes | no
11177 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011178 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11179 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011180
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011181 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11182 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011183
11184 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11185 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11186 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011187 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011188 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011189 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11190 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011191
11192 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11193 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11194 assign the backend.
11195
11196 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11197 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11198 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11199 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11200 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11201 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11202
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011203 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011204 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011205 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11206 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11207 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11208
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011209 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11210 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11211 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11212 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11213 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11214 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11215 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11216 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11217 cannot be forced from the request.
11218
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011219 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011220 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11221 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11222
11223 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11224 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011225
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011226
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011227use-server <server> if <condition>
11228use-server <server> unless <condition>
11229 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11231 no | no | yes | yes
11232 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011233 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011234
11235 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11236
11237 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11238 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11239 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11240
11241 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11242 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11243 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11244 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11245 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11246 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11247 matches will assign the server.
11248
11249 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11250 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11251 with the next rules until one matches.
11252
11253 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11254 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11255 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11256 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11257
11258 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11259 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11260 stripped.
11261
11262 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11263 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11264 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11265 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11266
11267 Example :
11268 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11269 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11270 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11271 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11272 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11273 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011274 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011275 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11276 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11277
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011278 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011279
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112815. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011282--------------------------
11283
11284The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11285depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11286settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11287written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11288described in this section.
11289
11290
112915.1. Bind options
11292-----------------
11293
11294The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11295as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11296no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11297parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11298while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11299provided immediately after the setting name.
11300
11301The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11302
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011303accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11304 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11305 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11306 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11307 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11308 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11309 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11310 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11311 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11312 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011313 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11314 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11315 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011316
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011317accept-proxy
11318 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011319 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11320 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011321 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11322 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11323 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11324 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011325 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011326 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11327 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011328 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11329 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011330
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011331allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011332 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011333 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011334 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011335 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11336 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011337
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011338alpn <protocols>
11339 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11340 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11341 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011342 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011343 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011344 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11345 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11346 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11347 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11348 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11349 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11350 preference, like below :
11351
11352 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011354backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011355 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011356 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11357
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011358curves <curves>
11359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11360 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11361 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11362 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11363 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11364 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11365
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011366ecdhe <named curve>
11367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011368 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11369 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011370
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011371ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11373 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11374 client's certificate.
11375
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011376ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11378 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11379 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11380 error is ignored.
11381
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011382ca-sign-file <cafile>
11383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11384 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11385 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11386 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11387 'generate-certificates' for details.
11388
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011389ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11391 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11392 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11393 'generate-certificates' for details.
11394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011395ciphers <ciphers>
11396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11397 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011398 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011399 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011400 information and recommendations see e.g.
11401 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11402 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11403 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11404
11405ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11407 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11408 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11409 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011410 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11411 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011412
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011413crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11415 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11416 to verify client's certificate.
11417
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011418crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011419 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11420 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11421 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11422 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11423 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11424 file.
11425
11426 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11427 are loaded.
11428
11429 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011430 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011431 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11432 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11433 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11434 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11436 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011437 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011438
11439 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11440 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11441 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11442 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011443 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11444 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011445
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011446 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011447
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011448 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011449 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011450 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11451 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011452 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11453 clients).
11454
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011455 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11456 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11457 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11458 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11459 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11460 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11461 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11462 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11463 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11464 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11465 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11466 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11467 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11468
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011469 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11470 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11471 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11472 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11473 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11474
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011475 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11476 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11477 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11478 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011479
11480 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11481 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11482 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11483 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11484 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11485 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11486 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11487 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11488 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11489
11490 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11491
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011492 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011493 a cert bundle.
11494
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011495 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011496 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11497 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11498 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11499 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11500 provide multi-cert support.
11501
11502 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11503
11504 Filename | CN | SAN
11505 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11506 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011507 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011508 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11509 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11510
11511 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11512 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11513 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11514 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011515 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11516 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11517 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011518
11519 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11520 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11521
11522 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11523 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11524 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11525
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011526crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011529 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011530 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011531
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011532crt-list <file>
11533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011534 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11535 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011536
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011537 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11538
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011539 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11540 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011541 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011542 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011543
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011544 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11545 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11546 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11547 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11548 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11549 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11550 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11551 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011552
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011553 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011554 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011555 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11556 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11557 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011558
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011559 crt-list file example:
11560 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011561 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011562 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011563 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011564
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011565defer-accept
11566 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11567 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11568 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011569 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011570 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11571 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11572 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11573 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11574 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11575 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11576 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11577
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011578expose-fd listeners
11579 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11580 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011581 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11582 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011583 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011584
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011585force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011586 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011587 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011588 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011589 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011590
11591force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011592 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011593 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011594 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011595
11596force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011597 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011598 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011599 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011600
11601force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011602 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011603 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011604 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011605
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011606force-tlsv13
11607 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11608 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011609 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011610
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011611generate-certificates
11612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11613 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11614 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11615 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11616 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11617 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11618 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11619 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11620 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11621 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11622 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11623
11624 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11625 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011626 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011627 certificate is used many times.
11628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011629gid <gid>
11630 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11631 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11632 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11633 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11634 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11635
11636group <group>
11637 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11638 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11639 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11640 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11641 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11642
11643id <id>
11644 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11645 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11646 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11647 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11648
11649interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011650 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11651 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11652 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11653 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11654 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11655 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011656 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11657 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11658 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11659 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11660 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11661 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011662
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011663level <level>
11664 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11665 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11666 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011668 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11669 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11670 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011671 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011672 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011673 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011674 all counters).
11675
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011676severity-output <format>
11677 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11678 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11679 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11680 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11681 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11682 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11683 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11684 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11685 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11686 rfc5424 convention.
11687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011688maxconn <maxconn>
11689 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11690 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11691 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11692 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11693 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11694 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11695 eat all memory.
11696
11697mode <mode>
11698 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11699 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11700 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11701 UNIX sockets.
11702
11703mss <maxseg>
11704 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11705 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11706 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11707 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11708 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11709 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11710 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11711 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11712 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11713 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11714 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11715
11716name <name>
11717 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11718 page.
11719
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011720namespace <name>
11721 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11722 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11723 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11724 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11725
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011726nice <nice>
11727 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11728 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11729 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11730 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11731 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11732 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11733 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11734 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11735 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11736 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11737 one for an RDP socket.
11738
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011739no-ca-names
11740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11741 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11742
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011743no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011744 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011745 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011746 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011747 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011748 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11749 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011750
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011751no-tls-tickets
11752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11753 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11754 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011755 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11756 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011757
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011758no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011759 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011760 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011761 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011762 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11764 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011765
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011766no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011768 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011769 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011770 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011771 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11772 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011773
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011774no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011776 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011777 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011778 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011779 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11780 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011781
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011782no-tlsv13
11783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11784 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11785 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11786 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011787 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11788 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011789
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011790npn <protocols>
11791 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11792 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11793 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011794 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011795 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011796 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11797 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11798 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11799 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11800 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011801
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011802prefer-client-ciphers
11803 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11804 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11805 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011806 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11807 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11808 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011809
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011810process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011811 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011812 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011813 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011814 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11815 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11816 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11817 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011818 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011819 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11820 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11821 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11822 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11823 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011824
11825 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11826
11827 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11828 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11829 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11830 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11831 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11832 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11833 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11834 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011835
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011836proto <name>
11837 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11838 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11839 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11840 in haproxy -vv.
11841 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11842 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011843 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011844 h2" on the bind line.
11845
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011846ssl
11847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011848 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011849 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11850 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011851 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11852 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011853
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011854ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11855 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11856 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11857 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11858
11859ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11860 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11861 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11862 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11863
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011864strict-sni
11865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11866 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11867 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11868 See the "crt" option for more information.
11869
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011870tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011871 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011872 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11873 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011874 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011875 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11876 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11877 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11878 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11879 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11880 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11881 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11882
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011883tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011884 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011885 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11886 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11887 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11888 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11889 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11890 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11891 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011892 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11893 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11894 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011895
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011896tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11897 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011898 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11899 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11900 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11901 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11902 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11903 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11904 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11905 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11906 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11907 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011908 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11909 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11910
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011911transparent
11912 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11913 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11914 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11915 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11916 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11917 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11918 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11919 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11920 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11921 so check for support with your vendor.
11922
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011923v4v6
11924 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11925 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11926 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11927 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011928 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011929
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011930v6only
11931 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11932 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11933 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011934 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11935 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011936
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011937uid <uid>
11938 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11939 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11940 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11941 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11942 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11943
11944user <user>
11945 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11946 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11947 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11948 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11949 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11950
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011951verify [none|optional|required]
11952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11953 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11954 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11955 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11956 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011957 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11958 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11959 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11960 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011961
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119625.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011963------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011965The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11966which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11967arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11968settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11969after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11970Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11971address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011973 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011974 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011975
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011976Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11977keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011979The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011980
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011981addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011982 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011983 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11984 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11985 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11986 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11987 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011988
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011989agent-check
11990 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011991 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011992 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11993 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11994 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011995
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011996 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011997 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011998 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11999 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12000 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012002 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12003 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12004 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12005 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12006 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012007
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012008 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012009 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012010
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012011 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12012 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12013 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012014
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012015 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12016 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12017 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012019 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12020 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12021 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12022 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12023 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012024 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012025 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012026
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012027 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12028 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012029
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012030 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12031 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12032 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12033 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12034 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12035 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12036 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12037 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12038 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012039
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012040 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12041 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012042 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12043 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12044 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012045 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012046
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012047 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012048 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012049
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012050agent-send <string>
12051 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12052 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12053 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12054 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12055 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12056
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012057agent-inter <delay>
12058 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12059 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12060
12061 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12062 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12063 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12064 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12065 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12066 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12067 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12068 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12069 of backends use the same servers.
12070
12071 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12072
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012073agent-addr <addr>
12074 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12075
12076 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12077 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12078 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12079 hostname, it will be resolved.
12080
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012081agent-port <port>
12082 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12083
12084 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12085
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012086allow-0rtt
12087 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012088 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12089 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012090
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012091alpn <protocols>
12092 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12093 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12094 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012095 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012096 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12097 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12098 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12099 now obsolete NPN extension.
12100 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12101 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12102
12103 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012105backup
12106 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12107 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12108 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12109 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012110 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12111 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012112
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012113ca-file <cafile>
12114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12115 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12116 server's certificate.
12117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012118check
12119 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012120 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12121 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12122 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12123 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12124 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12125 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12126 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012127 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12128 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012129 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12130 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012131
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012132check-send-proxy
12133 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12134 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12135 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12136 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12137 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12138 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12139 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12140
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012141check-alpn <protocols>
12142 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12143 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12144 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12145
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012146check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012147 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012148 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12149 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012150
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012151check-ssl
12152 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12153 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12154 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12155 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012156 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012157 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12158 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012159 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012160 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12161 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012162
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012163check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012164 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012165 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12166 for normal traffic.
12167
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012168ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12170 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12171 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012172 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12173 information and recommendations see e.g.
12174 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12175 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12176 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012177
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012178ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12180 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12181 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12182 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012183 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12184 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12185 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012187cookie <value>
12188 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12189 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12190 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12191 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12192 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12193 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12194 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12195
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012196crl-file <crlfile>
12197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12198 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12199 to verify server's certificate.
12200
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012201crt <cert>
12202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12203 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12204 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12205 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12206 certificate request.
12207
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012208disabled
12209 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12210 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12211 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12212 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12213 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012214 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012215
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012216enabled
12217 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12218 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12219 default value.
12220 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12221 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012223error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012224 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12225 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12226 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012228 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012230fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012231 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12232 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12233 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12234
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012235force-sslv3
12236 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12237 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012238 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012239 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012240
12241force-tlsv10
12242 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012243 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012244 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012245
12246force-tlsv11
12247 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012248 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012249 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012250
12251force-tlsv12
12252 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012253 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012254 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012255
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012256force-tlsv13
12257 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12258 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012259 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012261id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012262 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12263 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12264 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012265
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012266init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12267 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12268 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012269 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012270 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12271 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12272 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12273 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12274 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12275 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12276 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12277 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12278 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012279 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012280 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12281 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12282 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12283 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12284 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12285 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012286 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012287
12288 Example:
12289 defaults
12290 # never fail on address resolution
12291 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012293inter <delay>
12294fastinter <delay>
12295downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012296 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12297 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12298 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12299 between checks depending on the server state :
12300
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012301 Server state | Interval used
12302 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12303 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12304 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12305 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12306 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12307 or yet unchecked. |
12308 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12309 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12310 | "inter" otherwise.
12311 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12314 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12315 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12316 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012317 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12318 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12319 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12320 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12321 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012323maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012324 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12325 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012326 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12327 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012328 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12329 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12330 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12331 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12332
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012333 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12334 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12335 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12336 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12337 than 50 concurrent requests.
12338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012339maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012340 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12341 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12342 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12343 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12344 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12345 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12346 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12347
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012348max-reuse <count>
12349 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12350 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12351 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12352 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12353 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12354 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12355 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12356 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012358minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012359 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12360 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12361 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12362 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12363 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12364 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012365 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012366 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012367
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012368namespace <name>
12369 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12370 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12371 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12372 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012374no-agent-check
12375 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12376 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12377 default value.
12378 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12379 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12380
12381no-backup
12382 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12383 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12384 default value.
12385 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12386 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12387
12388no-check
12389 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12390 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12391 default value.
12392 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12393 "default-server" "check" setting.
12394
12395no-check-ssl
12396 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12397 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12398 default value.
12399 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12400 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12401
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012402no-send-proxy
12403 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12404 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12405 default value.
12406 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12407 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12408
12409no-send-proxy-v2
12410 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12411 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12412 default value.
12413 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12414 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12415
12416no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12417 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12418 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12419 default value.
12420 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12421 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12422
12423no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12424 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12425 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12426 default value.
12427 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12428 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12429
12430no-ssl
12431 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12432 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12433 default value.
12434 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12435 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12436
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012437no-ssl-reuse
12438 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12439 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12440 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12441 and for paranoid users.
12442
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012443no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012444 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12445 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012446 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012447
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012448 Supported in default-server: No
12449
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012450no-tls-tickets
12451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12452 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12453 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012454 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12455 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012456 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012457
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012458no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012459 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012460 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12461 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012462 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12463 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012464 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012465
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012466 Supported in default-server: No
12467
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012468no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012469 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012470 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12471 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012472 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12473 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012474 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012475
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012476 Supported in default-server: No
12477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012478no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012479 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012480 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12481 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012482 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12483 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012484 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012485
12486 Supported in default-server: No
12487
12488no-tlsv13
12489 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12490 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12491 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12492 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12493 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012494 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012495
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012496 Supported in default-server: No
12497
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012498no-verifyhost
12499 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12500 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12501 default value.
12502 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12503 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012504
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012505no-tfo
12506 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12507 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12508 default value.
12509 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12510 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12511
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012512non-stick
12513 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12514 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12515 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12516
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012517npn <protocols>
12518 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12519 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12520 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012521 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012522 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12523 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12524 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012526observe <mode>
12527 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12528 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12529 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12530 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12531 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12532 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012533 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012534
12535 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012537on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012538 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12539 Currently, four modes are available:
12540 - fastinter: force fastinter
12541 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12542 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12543 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12544 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12545
12546 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12547
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012548on-marked-down <action>
12549 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12550 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012551 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12552 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12553 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12554 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12555 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12556 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12557 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12558 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012559
12560 Actions are disabled by default
12561
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012562on-marked-up <action>
12563 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12564 Currently one action is available:
12565 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12566 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12567 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12568 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012569 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12570 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012571 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12572 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12573
12574 Actions are disabled by default
12575
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012576pool-max-conn <max>
12577 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12578 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12579 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12580 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12581 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12582 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12583
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012584pool-purge-delay <delay>
12585 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012586 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012587 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012589port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012590 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12591 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12592 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12593 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12594 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12595 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12596
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012597proto <name>
12598
12599 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12600 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12601 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12602 reported in haproxy -vv.
12603 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12604 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012606redir <prefix>
12607 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12608 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12609 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12610 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12611 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12612 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12613 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12614 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012615 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012616 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012617 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12618 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12619 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12620 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12621
12622 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012624rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012625 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12626 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12627 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12628
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012629resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12630 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12631 server.
12632
12633 Available options:
12634
12635 * allow-dup-ip
12636 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12637 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12638 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12639 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12640 For such case, simply enable this option.
12641 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12642
12643 * prevent-dup-ip
12644 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12645 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12646 same fqdn.
12647 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12648
12649 Example:
12650 backend b_myapp
12651 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12652 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12653 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12654
12655 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12656 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12657 it
12658 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12659 different address
12660
12661 Default value: not set
12662
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012663resolve-prefer <family>
12664 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12665 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12666 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12667 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12668
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012669 Default value: ipv6
12670
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012671 Example:
12672
12673 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012674
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012675resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012676 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012677 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012678 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012679 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12680 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012681 configured network, another address is selected.
12682
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012683 Example:
12684
12685 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012686
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012687resolvers <id>
12688 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12689 hostname.
12690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012691 Example:
12692
12693 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012694
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012695 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012696
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012697send-proxy
12698 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12699 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12700 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12701 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012702 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12703 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12704 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12705 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12706 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12707 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12708 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12709 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12710 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12711 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012712 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12713 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012714
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012715send-proxy-v2
12716 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12717 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12718 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12719 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012720 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12721 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12722 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12723 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012724
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012725proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12726 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12727 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012728 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12729 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012730 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12731 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012732 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012733
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012734send-proxy-v2-ssl
12735 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12736 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12737 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12738 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12739 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12740 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12741 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012742 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12743 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012744
12745send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12746 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12747 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12748 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12749 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12750 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12751 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12752 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12753 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012754 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12755 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012757slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012758 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12759 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12760 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12761 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12762 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12763 parameters :
12764
12765 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12766 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12767
12768 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12769 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12770 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12771 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12772
12773 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12774 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12775 seen as failed.
12776
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012777sni <expression>
12778 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12779 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12780 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12781 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012782 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12783 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012784 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012785 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12786 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012787
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012788source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012789source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012790source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012791 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12792 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12793 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12794 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12795
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012796 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12797 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12798 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12799 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12800 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12801 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12802 server.
12803
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012804 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12805 specifying the source address without port(s).
12806
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012807ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012808 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12809 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12810 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12811 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12812 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12813 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012814 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12815 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012816
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012817ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12818 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12819 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12820 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12821
12822ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12823 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12824 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12825 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12826
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012827ssl-reuse
12828 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12829 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12830 default value.
12831 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12832 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12833
12834stick
12835 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12836 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12837 default value.
12838 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12839 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012840
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012841socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012842 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012843 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12844 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12845
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012846tcp-ut <delay>
12847 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12848 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12849 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012850 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012851 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12852 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12853 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12854 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12855 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12856 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12857 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12858 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12859 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12860
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012861tfo
12862 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12863 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12864 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12865 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12866 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012867 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012869track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012870 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12871 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12872 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12873 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012874 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12875
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012876tls-tickets
12877 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12878 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12879 default value.
12880 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12881 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012882
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012883verify [none|required]
12884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012885 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012886 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12887 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012888 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012889 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12890 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12891 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12892 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12893 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12894 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12895 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12896 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012897
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012898verifyhost <hostname>
12899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012900 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12901 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12902 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12903 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12904 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12905 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12906 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12907 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012909weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012910 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12911 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12912 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012913 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12914 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12915 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12916 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12917 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12918 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012919
12920
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129215.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12922-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012923
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012924HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12925using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12926configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012927This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12928can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12929workload.
12930This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12931resolution at run time.
12932Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12933carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12934
12935
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129365.3.1. Global overview
12937----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012938
12939As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12940different steps of the process life:
12941
12942 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12943 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12944 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12945
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012946 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12947 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012948
12949A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12950 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12951 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12952 resolution to know this new IP.
12953
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012954When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012955HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012956SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12957from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12958will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12959will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012960
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012961A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012962 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012963 first valid response.
12964
12965 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12966 servers return an error.
12967
12968
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129695.3.2. The resolvers section
12970----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012971
12972This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012973HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12974contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012975
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012976When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12977uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12978is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12979answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12980
12981When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012982used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012983
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012984 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12985 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12986 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012987
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012988 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12989 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012990
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012991 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12992 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12993 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012994
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012995For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12996following scenarios are possible:
12997
12998 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12999 ignored
13000
13001 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13002 applied
13003
13004 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13005 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13006
13007 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13008 retries the query with a new type
13009
13010 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13011 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013012
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013013As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13014a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013015<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013016
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013017
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013018resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013019 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013020
13021A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13022
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013023accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013024 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013025 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013026 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13027 by RFC 6891)
13028
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013029 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13030
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013031nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13032 DNS server description:
13033 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13034 <ip> : IP address of the server
13035 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13036
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013037parse-resolv-conf
13038 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13039 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13040 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13041
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013042hold <status> <period>
13043 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13044 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013045 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013046 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013047 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13048 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13049 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13050
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013051 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013052
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013053resolve_retries <nb>
13054 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13055 giving up.
13056 Default value: 3
13057
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013058 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13059 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13060 type.
13061
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013062timeout <event> <time>
13063 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13064 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13065 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013066 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13067 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013068 Default value: 1s
13069 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013070 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013071 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013072 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13073 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013075 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013076
13077 resolvers mydns
13078 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13079 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013080 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013081 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013082 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013083 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013084 hold other 30s
13085 hold refused 30s
13086 hold nx 30s
13087 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013088 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013089 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013090
13091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130926. HTTP header manipulation
13093---------------------------
13094
13095In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13096response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13097request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13098which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013099against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013100
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013101If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13102to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13103but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13104HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13105stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13106because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13107a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13108still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013110This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13111in section 4.2 :
13112
13113 - reqadd <string>
13114 - reqallow <search>
13115 - reqiallow <search>
13116 - reqdel <search>
13117 - reqidel <search>
13118 - reqdeny <search>
13119 - reqideny <search>
13120 - reqpass <search>
13121 - reqipass <search>
13122 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13123 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13124 - reqtarpit <search>
13125 - reqitarpit <search>
13126 - rspadd <string>
13127 - rspdel <search>
13128 - rspidel <search>
13129 - rspdeny <search>
13130 - rspideny <search>
13131 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13132 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13133
13134With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13135is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13136parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13137prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13138Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13139
13140 \t for a tab
13141 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13142 \n for a new line (LF)
13143 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13144 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13145 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13146 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13147 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13148
13149The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13150portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13151above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13152regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
131539 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13154is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13155
13156The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13157after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13158
13159Notes related to these keywords :
13160---------------------------------
13161 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13162 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13163 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13164
13165 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13166 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13167 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13168
13169 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13170 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13171 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13172 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13173 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13174
13175 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13176 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13177 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13178 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13179 useless headers before adding new ones.
13180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013181 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013182 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13183
13184 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13185 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13186 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13187
13188 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13189 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013190 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013191
13192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13194----------------------------------
13195
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013196HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13198The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13199these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13200but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13201data called patterns.
13202
13203
132047.1. ACL basics
13205---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013206
13207The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13208content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13209from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13210simple :
13211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013213 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13215 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13218adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013219
13220In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013222 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013223
13224This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13225Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13226and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013227an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13228conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13229as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13230are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013231
13232ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13233'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13234which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13235
13236There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13237performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13240specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13241this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013242methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13243ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244
13245Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13246 - boolean
13247 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13248 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13249 - string
13250 - data block
13251
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013252Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13253converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13254would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13255The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13256which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13257
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013258Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13259keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13260fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13261which are summarized in the table below :
13262
13263 +---------------------+-----------------+
13264 | Sample or converter | Default |
13265 | output type | matching method |
13266 +---------------------+-----------------+
13267 | boolean | bool |
13268 +---------------------+-----------------+
13269 | integer | int |
13270 +---------------------+-----------------+
13271 | ip | ip |
13272 +---------------------+-----------------+
13273 | string | str |
13274 +---------------------+-----------------+
13275 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13276 +---------------------+-----------------+
13277
13278Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13279matching method, see below.
13280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13282 - boolean
13283 - integer or integer range
13284 - IP address / network
13285 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13286 - regular expression
13287 - hex block
13288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013289The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13290
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013291 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13292 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013294 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013295 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013296 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013297 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013299The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13300read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13301if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13302lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13303will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13304beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13305a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13306lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13307exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13308
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013309The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13310parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13311ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13312a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13313check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13314
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013315The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13316socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13317file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13320loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13321
13322 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13323
13324In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13325the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13326case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13327as well.
13328
13329The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13330sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13331do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13332methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13333is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013334obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13336default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13337that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13338string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13339
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013340The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13341By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13342string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13343resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13344server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013345waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013346flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13347function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13350sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13351be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013352
13353 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13354 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13356 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13357 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13358 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013359
13360 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13361 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013363
13364 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013366
13367 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013371 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13372
13373 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13374 binary or string samples.
13375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13377 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13380 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13381 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13384 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13387 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013389 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13390 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13393 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013394 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13397 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13398 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013399
13400For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13401request, it is possible to do :
13402
13403 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13404
13405In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13406buffer, one would use the following acl :
13407
13408 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13409
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013410On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13411possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13412
13413 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13416criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13417method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13418to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13419criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13420the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013423the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13424For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13427 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13428 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13429 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013430
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013431
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013432The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13433types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13434combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13435brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13436default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438 +-------------------------------------------------+
13439 | Input sample type |
13440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013441 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13443 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013445 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013447 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013449 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013451 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013453 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013455 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013457 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013459 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013461 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013463 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013465 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13467 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013469
13470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134717.1.1. Matching booleans
13472------------------------
13473
13474In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13475Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13476When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13477that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13478
13479Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13480return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13481"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134847.1.2. Matching integers
13485------------------------
13486
13487Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13488enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13489to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13490
13491Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13492matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13493lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013494
13495For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13496unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13497representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13498
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013499As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13500two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13501instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13502ranges and operators.
13503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013504For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013505operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13506Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13507of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013509Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013510
13511 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13512 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13513 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13514 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13515 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013517For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013518
13519 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13520
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013521This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13522
13523 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135267.1.3. Matching strings
13527-----------------------
13528
13529String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13530different forms :
13531
13532 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534
13535 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013536 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537
13538 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13539 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13540
13541 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13542 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13543
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013544 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13546 matches.
13547
13548 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13549 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13550 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013551
13552String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13553exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13554characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13555string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13556to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013557before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013558
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013559Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13560(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13561Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13562
13563Example:
13564 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13565 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135687.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13569---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013570
13571Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13572they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13573possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13574passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13575the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013576the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13577match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013578
13579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13581-------------------------------------
13582
13583It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13584not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13585a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13586to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13587digits may be used upper or lower case.
13588
13589Example :
13590 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13591 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13592
13593
135947.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13595---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013596
13597IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13598netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13599within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013600host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013601difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13602at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13603does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13604parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013605
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013606The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13607abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13608
13609 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13610 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13611 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13612 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13613 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13614 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13615 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13616 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13617
13618Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13619192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13620
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013621IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13622Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13623trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13624IPv6 patterns.
13625
13626HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13627following situations :
13628 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13629 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13630 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13631 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13632 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13633 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13634 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13635 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13636 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13637 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639
136407.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13641----------------------------------
13642
13643Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13644combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13645
13646 - AND (implicit)
13647 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13648 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13655indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013657For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13658"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13659requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13660is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13661
13662 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013663 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13664 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13665 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666
13667To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13668and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13669
13670 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13671 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13672 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13673 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13674
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013675 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13677 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13678 use_backend www if host_www
13679
13680It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13681expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13682be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13683the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13684
13685 The following rule :
13686
13687 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013688 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013689
13690 Can also be written that way :
13691
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013692 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693
13694It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13695to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13696simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13697sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13698good use is the following :
13699
13700 With named ACLs :
13701
13702 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13703 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13704 monitor fail if site_dead
13705
13706 With anonymous ACLs :
13707
13708 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13709
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013710See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13711keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712
13713
137147.3. Fetching samples
13715---------------------
13716
13717Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13718against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13719sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13720ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13721of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13722available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13723
13724This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13725Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13726compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13727deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13728
13729The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13730matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13731method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13732indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13733
13734As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13735when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13736mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13737the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13738ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13739
13740Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13741multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13742when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013743incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13744are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13746all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13747
13748Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13749 - name
13750 - name(arg1)
13751 - name(arg1,arg2)
13752
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013753
137547.3.1. Converters
13755-----------------
13756
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013757Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13758of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13759is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13760was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013762unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13763
13764These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13765sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13766the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013767support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013768
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013769A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13770support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13771supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13772(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13773bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013775The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013776
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001377751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13778 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13779 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13780 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13781 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13782 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13783
13784 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013785 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13786 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013787 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13788 frontend http-in
13789 bind *:8081
13790 default_backend servers
13791 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13792 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13793
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013794add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013795 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013796 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013797 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13798 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13802 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13803 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013804 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013805 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013806
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013807aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13808 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13809 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13810 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13811 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13812 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13813 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13814
13815 Example:
13816 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13817 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013819and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013820 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013821 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013822 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13823 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013824 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013825 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13826 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13827 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13828 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013829 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013830 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013831
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013832b64dec
13833 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13834 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13835
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013836base64
13837 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013839 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13840
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013841bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013842 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013843 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013844 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013845 presence of a flag).
13846
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013847bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13848 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13849 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013850 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013851
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013852concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13853 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13854 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13855 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13856 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13857 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13858 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13859 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13860 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13861 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13862 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013863 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013864 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013865 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013866
13867 Example:
13868 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13869 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13870 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13871 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13872
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013873cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013874 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13875 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013876
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013877crc32([<avalanche>])
13878 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13879 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13880 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13881 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13882 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13883 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13884 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13885 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13886 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13887 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013888 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13889
13890crc32c([<avalanche>])
13891 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13892 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13893 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13894 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13895 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13896 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13897 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13898 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013899
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013900da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013901 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13902 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13903 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13904 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013905 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013906 configuration language.
13907
13908 Example:
13909 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013910 bind *:8881
13911 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013912 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013913
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013914debug
13915 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13916 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13917 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13918
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013919div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013920 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13921 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013922 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013923 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13924 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013925 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013926 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13927 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13928 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13929 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013930 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013931 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013932
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013933djb2([<avalanche>])
13934 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13935 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13936 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13937 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13938 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13939 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13940 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013941 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13942 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013944even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013945 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013946 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13947
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013948field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13949 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13950 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13951 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13952 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13953 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13954 fields.
13955
13956 Example :
13957 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13958 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13959 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13960 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13961 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013962
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013963hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013964 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013965 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013966 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013967 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013968
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013969hex2i
13970 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013971 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013973http_date([<offset>])
13974 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13975 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13976 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13977 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13978 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13979 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013981in_table(<table>)
13982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13984 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013985 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013986 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13987
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013988ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13989 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013990 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013991 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13992 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13993 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13994 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13995 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013996
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013997json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013998 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013999 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014000 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014001 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14002 of errors:
14003 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14004 bytes, ...)
14005 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14006 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14007
14008 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14009 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14010 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14011 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14012 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14013 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 - "ascii" : never fails;
14015 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14016 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014017 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014018 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014019 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14020 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14021
14022 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014023 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014024
14025 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014026 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014027 capture request header user-agent len 150
14028 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014029
14030 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14031 GET / HTTP/1.0
14032 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14033
14034 Output log:
14035 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014037language(<value>[,<default>])
14038 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14039 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14040 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14041 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14042 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14043 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14044 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14045 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14046 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014048 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14049 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014050
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014051 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014053 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14054 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014056 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14057 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14058 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14059 use_backend spanish if es
14060 use_backend french if fr
14061 use_backend english if en
14062 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014063
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014064length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014065 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14066 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14067 type. The result is of type integer.
14068
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014069lower
14070 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14071 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14072 type. The result is of type string.
14073
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014074ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14075 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14076 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14077 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14078 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14079 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14080 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14081
14082 Example :
14083
14084 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014085 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014086 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14087
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014088map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14089map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14090map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14091 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14092 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14093 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14094 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14095 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14096 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14097 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14098 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014100 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14101 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14102 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014103
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014104 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014105 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014106
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014107 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14108 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14109 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14110 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014111 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14112 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014113 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14114 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14115 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14116 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14117 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14118 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14119 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14120 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014121 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14122 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14123 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014124 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14125 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14126 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14127 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14128 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014129
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014130 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14131 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14132 the corresponding match text.
14133
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014134 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14135 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14136 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14137 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14138 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014139
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014140 Example :
14141
14142 # this is a comment and is ignored
14143 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14144 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14145 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14146 | | | `---------- value
14147 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14148 | `---------------------------- key
14149 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14150
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014151mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014152 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14153 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014154 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014155 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014156 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014157 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14158 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14159 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14160 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014162 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014163
14164mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014165 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014166 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14167 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014168 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014169 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014170 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014171 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14172 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14173 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014175 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014176 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014177
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014178nbsrv
14179 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14180 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14181 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14182 map lookup.
14183
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014184neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014185 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14186 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14187 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14188 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014189
14190not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014191 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014192 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014193 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014194 absence of a flag).
14195
14196odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014197 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014198 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14199
14200or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014201 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014202 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014203 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14204 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014205 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014206 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14207 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14209 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014211 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014212
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014213protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14214 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14215 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14216 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14217 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14218 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14219 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14220 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14221 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14222 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14223 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14224 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14225
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014226regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014227 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14228 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14229 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14230 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14231 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14232 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14233 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14234 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14235 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14236 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014237 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14238 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14239 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14240 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014241
14242 Example :
14243
14244 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14245 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14246 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14247 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14248
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014249capture-req(<id>)
14250 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14251 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14252
14253 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014254 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14255 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014256
14257capture-res(<id>)
14258 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14259 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14260
14261 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014262 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14263 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014264
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014265sdbm([<avalanche>])
14266 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14267 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14268 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14269 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14270 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14271 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14272 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014273 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14274 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014275
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014276set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014277 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14278 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14279 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014283 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014288
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014289sha1
14290 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14291 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14292
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014293strcmp(<var>)
14294 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14295 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14296 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14297 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14298 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14299 shorter).
14300
14301 Example :
14302
14303 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14304 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14305 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14306
14307
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014308sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014309 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14310 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014311 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014312 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14313 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014314 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014315 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14316 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014317 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014318 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014320 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014321 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014322
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014323table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14327 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14328 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14329 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14330
14331
14332table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14336 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14337 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14338 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14339
14340table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014344 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14345 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14346
14347table_conn_cur(<table>)
14348 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14349 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14350 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14351 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14352 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14353
14354table_conn_rate(<table>)
14355 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14356 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14357 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14358 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14359 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14360
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014361table_gpt0(<table>)
14362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14365 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14366 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14367
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014368table_gpc0(<table>)
14369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14371 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14372 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14373 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14374
14375table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14376 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14377 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14378 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14379 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14380 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14381 sample fetch keyword.
14382
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014383table_gpc1(<table>)
14384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14387 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14388 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14389
14390table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14391 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14392 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14393 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14394 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14395 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14396 sample fetch keyword.
14397
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014398table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014401 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014402 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14403 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14404
14405table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14408 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14409 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14410 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14411 keyword.
14412
14413table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014417 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14418 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14419
14420table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14421 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14422 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14423 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14424 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14425 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14426 keyword.
14427
14428table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014432 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14433 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14434 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14435 keyword.
14436
14437table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014441 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14442 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14443 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14444 keyword.
14445
14446table_server_id(<table>)
14447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14449 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14450 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14451 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14452 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14453
14454table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014458 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14459 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14460 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14461 keyword.
14462
14463table_sess_rate(<table>)
14464 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14465 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14466 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14467 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14468 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14469 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14470 keyword.
14471
14472table_trackers(<table>)
14473 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14474 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14475 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14476 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14477 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14478 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14479 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14480 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14481 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14482 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14483
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014484upper
14485 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14486 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14487 type. The result is of type string.
14488
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014489url_dec
14490 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14491 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14492
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014493ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014494 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014495 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14496 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14497 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014498 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14499 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14500 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14501 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014502 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014503 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14504 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014505
14506 Example:
14507 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14508 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14509
14510 message Point {
14511 int32 latitude = 1;
14512 int32 longitude = 2;
14513 }
14514
14515 message PPoint {
14516 Point point = 59;
14517 }
14518
14519 message Rectangle {
14520 // One corner of the rectangle.
14521 PPoint lo = 48;
14522 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14523 PPoint hi = 49;
14524 }
14525
14526 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14527 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14528 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14529
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014530 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14531 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014532 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014533 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14534
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014535 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014536
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014537 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014538
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014539 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014540 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14541 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14542
14543 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14544 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14545 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14546
14547 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14548 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14549 interpret the previous binary sample.
14550
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014551
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014552unset-var(<var name>)
14553 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14554 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14555 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14556 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14557 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14558 response),
14559 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14560 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14561 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14562 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14563
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014564utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14565 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14566 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14567 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14568 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14569 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14570 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14571
14572 Example :
14573
14574 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014575 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014576 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14577
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014578word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14579 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14580 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14581 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14582 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14583 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14584
14585 Example :
14586 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14587 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14588 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14589 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14590 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014591
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014592wt6([<avalanche>])
14593 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14594 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14595 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14596 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14597 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14598 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14599 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014600 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14601 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014602
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014603xor(<value>)
14604 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014605 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014606 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014607 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014608 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014609 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14610 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014611 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014612 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14613 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014614 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014615 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014616
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014617xxh32([<seed>])
14618 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14619 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14620 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14621 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14622 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14623 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14624 as cryptographically secure.
14625
14626xxh64([<seed>])
14627 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14628 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14629 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14630 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14631 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14632 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14633 as cryptographically secure.
14634
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014635
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146367.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014637--------------------------------------------
14638
14639A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14640not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14641"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14642The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14643
14644always_false : boolean
14645 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14646 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14647
14648always_true : boolean
14649 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14650 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14651
14652avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014653 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14655 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14656 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14657 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14658 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14659 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14660 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14661 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14662 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14663 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14664 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14665 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14666 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014669 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14670 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14671 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14672 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014673 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14674
14675be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14677 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14678 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14679 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14680 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014681 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14682 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014683
14684 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14685 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14686 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14689 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14690 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14691 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014692 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14694 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014695
14696 Example :
14697 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14698 backend dynamic
14699 mode http
14700 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14701 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014702
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014703bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014704 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14705 of the string.
14706
14707bool(<bool>) : bool
14708 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14709 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14712 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014713 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14715 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014716
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014717 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014718 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014719 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14720
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014721 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14722 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014723
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014724 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014725 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014726 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014727 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014728 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014730 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014731
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014732 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14733 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014734 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014735 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014736
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014737cpu_calls : integer
14738 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14739 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14740 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14741 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14742 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14743 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14744
14745cpu_ns_avg : integer
14746 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14747 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14748 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14749 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14750 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14751 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14752 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14753 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14754 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14755 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14756 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14757
14758cpu_ns_tot : integer
14759 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14760 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14761 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14762 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14763 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14764 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14765 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14766 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14767 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14768 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14769 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14770 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14771 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14772
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014773date([<offset>]) : integer
14774 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14775 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14776 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14777 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014778 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14779
14780 Example :
14781
14782 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14783 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014784
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014785date_us : integer
14786 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14787 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14788 from the same timeval structure.
14789
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014790distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14791 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14792 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14793 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14794 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14795 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14796 list of supported tokens.
14797
14798distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14799 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14800 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14801 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14802 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14803 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14804 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14805 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14806 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14807 supported tokens.
14808
14809 Example :
14810 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14811 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14812 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14813 # send large files to the big farm
14814 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14815
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014816env(<name>) : string
14817 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14818 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14819 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14820 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14821 certain way.
14822
14823 Examples :
14824 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14825 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14826
14827 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14828 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14831 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014832 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14833 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14835 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014836 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14838 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014839
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014840fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14841 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14842 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14843 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14847 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14848 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14849 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14850 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14851 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14852 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14853 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014854
14855 Example :
14856 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14857 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14858 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14859 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14860 frontend mail
14861 bind :25
14862 mode tcp
14863 maxconn 100
14864 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14865 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14866 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14867 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014868
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014869hostname : string
14870 Returns the system hostname.
14871
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014872int(<integer>) : signed integer
14873 Returns a signed integer.
14874
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014875ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14876 Returns an ipv4.
14877
14878ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14879 Returns an ipv6.
14880
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014881lat_ns_avg : integer
14882 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14883 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14884 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14885 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14886 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14887 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14888 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14889 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14890 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14891 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14892 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14893 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14894 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14895 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14896
14897lat_ns_tot : integer
14898 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14899 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14900 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14901 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14902 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14903 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14904 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14905 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14906 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14907 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14908 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14909 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14910 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14911 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14912 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14913 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14914 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14915 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14916 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14917
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014918meth(<method>) : method
14919 Returns a method.
14920
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014921nbproc : integer
14922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14923 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14924 and debugging purposes.
14925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14927 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14928 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14929 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014930 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14931 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14932 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014933
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014934prio_class : integer
14935 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14936 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14937 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14938
14939prio_offset : integer
14940 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14941 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14942 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14943 set-priority-offset".
14944
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014945proc : integer
14946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14947 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14948 debugging purposes.
14949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014951 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14952 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14953 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14955 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14956 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14957 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14958 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14959
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014960rand([<range>]) : integer
14961 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14962 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14963 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14964 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14965 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14966
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014967uuid([<version>]) : string
14968 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14969 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14970 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14974 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14975 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14976 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14977 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014978 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14979 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14980
14981srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14983 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14984 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14985 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14986 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14987 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14988 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14989
14990 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14991 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992
14993srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14994 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14995 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14996 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014997 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14999 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15000 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15001
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015002srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15003 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15004 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15005 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15006 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15007 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15008 fetch methods.
15009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15011 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15012 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015013 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15015 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015016 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017 overloading servers).
15018
15019 Example :
15020 # Redirect to a separate back
15021 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15022 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15023 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15024
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015025stopping : boolean
15026 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15027 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15028 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15029
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015030str(<string>) : string
15031 Returns a string.
15032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15034 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15035 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15036
15037table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15038 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15039 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15040 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15041
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015042thread : integer
15043 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15044 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15045 and debugging purposes.
15046
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015047var(<var-name>) : undefined
15048 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015049 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15050 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15053 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015054 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15056 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015057 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015058 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015059
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150607.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061----------------------------------
15062
15063The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15064closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15065methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15066sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15067TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015068the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15069counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015070"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15071used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15072can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15073Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15074table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15075tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15076currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015078bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015079 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15080 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15081 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083be_id : integer
15084 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15085 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15086
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015087be_name : string
15088 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15089 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091dst : ip
15092 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15093 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15094 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15095 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015096 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15097 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15098 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15099 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15100 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15101 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102
15103dst_conn : integer
15104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15105 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15106 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15107 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15108 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15109 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15110 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15111 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015112
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015113dst_is_local : boolean
15114 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15115 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15116 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15117 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015118 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015119 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15120 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15121 it only once per connection.
15122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123dst_port : integer
15124 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15125 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15126 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15127 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15128 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15129 an HTTP header.
15130
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015131fc_http_major : integer
15132 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15133 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15134 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15135
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015136fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15137 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15138 header.
15139
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015140fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15141 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15142 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15143 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15144 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15145 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15146 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15147
15148fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15149 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15150 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15151 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15152 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15153 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15154 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15155
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015156fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015157 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15158 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15159 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15160 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15161
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015162fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015163 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15164 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15165 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15166 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15167
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015168fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015169 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15170 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15171 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15172 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15173
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015174fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015175 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15176 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15177 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15178 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15179
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015180fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015181 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15182 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15183 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15184 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15185
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015186fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015187 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15188 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15189 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15190 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15191
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015192fe_defbe : string
15193 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15194 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196fe_id : integer
15197 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015198 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15200
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015201fe_name : string
15202 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15203 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15204 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15205
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015206sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015207sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15208sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15209sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015210 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15211 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15212 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015214sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015215sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15216sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15217sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015218 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15219 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15220 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15221
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015222sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015223sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15224sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15225sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015226 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15227 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015228 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15229 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15230 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015231
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015232 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015233 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15234 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015235 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15236 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15237 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015238 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15239 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15240
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015241sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15242sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15243sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15244sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15245 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15246 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15247 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15248 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15249 when a first ACL was verified.
15250
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015251sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015252sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15253sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15254sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015255 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015256 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15257
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015258sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015259sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15260sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15261sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015262 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15263 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15264 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015266sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015267sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15268sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15269sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015270 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15271 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15272 See also src_conn_rate.
15273
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015274sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015275sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15276sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15277sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015278 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015279 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015280
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015281sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15282sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15283sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15284sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15285 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15286 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15287
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015288sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15289sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15290sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15291sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15292 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15293 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015295sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015296sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15297sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15298sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015299 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15300 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15301 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015302 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15303 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15304 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015305
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015306sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15307sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15308sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15309sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15310 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15311 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15312 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15313 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15314 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15315 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015317sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015318sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15319sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15320sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015321 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015322 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15323 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015325sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015326sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15327sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15328sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015329 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15330 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15331 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15332 src_http_err_rate.
15333
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015334sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015335sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15336sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15337sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015338 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015339 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15340 src_http_req_cnt.
15341
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015342sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015343sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15344sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15345sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015346 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15347 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15348 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15349 src_http_req_rate.
15350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015351sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015352sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15353sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15354sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015355 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015356 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15357 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15358 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15359 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015360
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015361 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015362 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15363 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015364 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15365
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015366sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15367sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15371 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15372 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15373 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15374 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015376sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015377sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15378sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15379sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015380 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15381 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15382 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015384sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015385sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15386sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15387sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015388 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15389 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15390 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015392sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015393sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15394sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15395sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015396 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015397 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15398 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15399 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015400 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015401 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015403sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015404sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15405sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15406sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15408 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15409 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15410 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15411 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015412 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015414sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015415sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15416sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15417sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015418 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15419 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15420 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015422sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015423sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15424sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15425sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015426 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15427 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015428 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015429 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15430 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15432 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15433 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435so_id : integer
15436 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15437 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15438 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015441 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15443 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15444 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015445 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15446 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15447 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015448 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15449 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15450 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15451 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15452 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15453 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15454 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015455
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015456 Example:
15457 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15458 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15461 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15462 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15463 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015464 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15467 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15468 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015469 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015470 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15473 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15474 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15475 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15476 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15477 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15478 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015479
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015480 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015481 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15482 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15483 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15484 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015485 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015486 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15487 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15488
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015489src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15490 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15491 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15492 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15493 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15494 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15495 was verified.
15496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015498 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015500 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015501 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015504 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15506 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015507 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15510 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15511 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15512 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015513 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015516 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015518 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015519 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015520
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015521src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15522 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15523 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15524 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15525 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15526
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015527src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15528 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15529 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15530 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15531 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015534 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015536 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15537 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015538 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15539 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15540 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015541
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015542src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15543 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15544 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15545 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15546 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15547 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15548 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15549 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015552 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015554 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015555 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15559 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15560 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15561 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15562 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015563 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015566 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15568 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015569 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15572 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15573 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15574 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015575 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015576 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15579 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15580 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15581 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015582 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15584 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015585
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015586 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015587 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015588 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015589 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015590
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015591src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15592 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15593 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15594 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15595 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15596 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15597 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15598
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015599src_is_local : boolean
15600 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15601 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15602 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15603 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015604 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015605 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15606 once per connection.
15607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015609 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15610 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15611 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15612 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15613 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015616 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15617 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15618 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15619 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15620 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622src_port : integer
15623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15624 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15625 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15626 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015630 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15631 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15632 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015633 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15636 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15637 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15638 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15639 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015640 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15643 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15644 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15645 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15646 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15647 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15648 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15649 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15650 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015651
15652 Example :
15653 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15654 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15655 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15656 listen ssh
15657 bind :22
15658 mode tcp
15659 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015660 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015662 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664srv_id : integer
15665 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15666 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15667 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015668
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156697.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15673closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15674when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15675usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015676future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015677
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001567851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15679 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15680 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15681 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15682 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15683 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15684
15685 Example :
15686 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15687 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15688 # the request.
15689 frontend http-in
15690 bind *:8081
15691 default_backend servers
15692 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15693 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15694
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015695ssl_bc : boolean
15696 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15697 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15698 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15699
15700ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15701 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15702 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15703
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015704ssl_bc_alpn : string
15705 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15706 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015707 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015708 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15709 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15710 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15711 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15712 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15713 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15714
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015715ssl_bc_cipher : string
15716 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15717 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15718
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015719ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15720 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15721 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15722 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15723
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015724ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15725 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15726 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15727 session or a TLS ticket.
15728
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015729ssl_bc_npn : string
15730 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15731 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015732 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015733 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15734 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15735 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15736 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15737 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15738
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015739ssl_bc_protocol : string
15740 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15741 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15742
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015743ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015744 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015745 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15746 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015747
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015748ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15749 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15750 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15751 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15752
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015753ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15754 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15755 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15756 if session was reused or not.
15757
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015758ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15759 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15760 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15761 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15762 BoringSSL.
15763
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015764ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15765 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15766 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15770 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15771 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15772 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15773 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15776 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15777 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15778 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15779 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015780
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015781ssl_c_der : binary
15782 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15783 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15784 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786ssl_c_err : integer
15787 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15788 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15789 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15790 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15791 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15794 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15795 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15796 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15797 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15798 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15799 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15800 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15801 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803ssl_c_key_alg : string
15804 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15805 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15806 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808ssl_c_notafter : string
15809 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15810 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15811 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813ssl_c_notbefore : string
15814 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15815 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15816 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15819 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15820 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15821 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15822 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15823 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15824 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15825 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15826 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828ssl_c_serial : binary
15829 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15830 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15831 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15834 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15835 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15836 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015837 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15838 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15839
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015840 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015841 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15844 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15845 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15846 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848ssl_c_used : boolean
15849 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15850 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852ssl_c_verify : integer
15853 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15854 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15855 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15856 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858ssl_c_version : integer
15859 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15860 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015861
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015862ssl_f_der : binary
15863 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15864 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15865 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15868 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15869 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15870 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15871 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015872 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15874 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15875 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877ssl_f_key_alg : string
15878 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15879 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15880 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882ssl_f_notafter : string
15883 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15884 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15885 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887ssl_f_notbefore : string
15888 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15889 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15890 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15894 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15895 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15896 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15897 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15898 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15899 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15900 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902ssl_f_serial : binary
15903 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15904 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15905 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015906
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015907ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15908 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15909 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15910 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15913 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15914 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15915 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917ssl_f_version : integer
15918 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15919 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15920
15921ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015922 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15923 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15924 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926 Example :
15927 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15928 listen http-https
15929 bind :80
15930 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15931 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15932
15933ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15934 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15935 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15936
15937ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015938 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15940 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15941 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15942 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15943 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15944 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15945 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15946 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948ssl_fc_cipher : string
15949 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15950 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015951
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015952ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15953 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15954 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015955 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015956
15957ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15958 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15959 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015960 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015961
15962ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15963 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15964 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15965 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015967 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015968
15969ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15970 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15971 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015972 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015973
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015974ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15975 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15976 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15977 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015980 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15981 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015982 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15983 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15984 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15985 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015986
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015987ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15988 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15989 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15990 wait until the handshake happened.
15991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15993 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015994 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15995 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015996 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015997 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015998
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015999ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016000 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016001 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16002 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016005 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16007 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16008 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16009 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16010 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16011 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16012 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014ssl_fc_protocol : string
16015 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16016 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016017
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016018ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016019 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016020 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16021 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016022
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016023ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16024 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16025 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16026 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16029 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16030 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16031 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16032 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016033
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016034ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16035 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16036 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16037 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16038 BoringSSL.
16039
16040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041ssl_fc_sni : string
16042 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16043 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16044 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16045 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16046 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16047
16048 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16049 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16050 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016051 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016052 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16056 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16059 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16060 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016061
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160637.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16067sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16068only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16069For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16070be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16071can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16072sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16073for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16074content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016077 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16079 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16082 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016083 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016085
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016086req.hdrs : string
16087 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16088 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16089 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16090 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16091
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016092req.hdrs_bin : binary
16093 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16094 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16095 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16096 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16097 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16098 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16099
16100 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16101
16102 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16103 str: <int:length><bytes>
16104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105req.len : integer
16106req_len : integer (deprecated)
16107 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16108 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16109 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16110 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16111 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16112 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16113 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16114 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16117 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016118 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16119 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16120 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16121 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123 ACL alternatives :
16124 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16127 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16128 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16129 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16130 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 ACL alternatives :
16133 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137req.proto_http : boolean
16138req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16139 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16140 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16141 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16142 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16143 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16144 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16145 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147 Example:
16148 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16149 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16150 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016151 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16154rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16155 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16156 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16157 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16158 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16159 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16160 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16161 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16164 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16165 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16166 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16167 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16168 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170 ACL derivatives :
16171 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173 Example :
16174 listen tse-farm
16175 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16176 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16177 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16178 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16179 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16180 persist rdp-cookie
16181 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16182 # This is only useful makes sense if
16183 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16184 stick-table type string size 204800
16185 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16186 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16187 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16190 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16193rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16194 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16195 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16196 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16197 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 ACL derivatives :
16200 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016201
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016202req.ssl_alpn : string
16203 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16204 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16205 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16206 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16207 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16208 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016209 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016210
16211 Examples :
16212 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16213 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16214 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016215 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016216 default_backend bk_default
16217
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016218req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16219 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16220 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016221 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16222 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16223 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16224 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16225 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16228req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16229 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16230 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16231 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16232 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16233 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16234 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16235 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237req.ssl_sni : string
16238req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16239 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16240 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16241 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16242 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16243 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16244 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16245 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16246 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16247 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16248 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16249 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16250 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 ACL derivatives :
16253 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 Examples :
16256 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16257 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16258 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16259 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16260 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016261
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016262req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16263 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16264 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16265 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16266 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16267 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16268 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16269 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16270 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16271 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273req.ssl_ver : integer
16274req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16275 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16276 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16277 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16278 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16279 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16280 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16281 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016282 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285 ACL derivatives :
16286 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016287
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016288res.len : integer
16289 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16290 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16291 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16292 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16293 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16294 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16295 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16296 content inspection.
16297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16299 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016300 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16301 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16302 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16303 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16306 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16307 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16308 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16309 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016311 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016312
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016313res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16314rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16315 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16316 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16317 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16318 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16319 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16320 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16321 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323wait_end : boolean
16324 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16325 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16328 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016329 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16331 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333 Examples :
16334 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16335 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16336 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16339 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16340 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16341 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16342 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16343 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16344 tcp-request content reject
16345
16346
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163477.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016348--------------------------------------
16349
16350It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16351This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16352data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16353its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16354HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16355content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16356to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16357more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16358response are indexed.
16359
16360base : string
16361 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16362 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16363 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16364 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16365 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16366 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16367 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16368 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16369
16370 ACL derivatives :
16371 base : exact string match
16372 base_beg : prefix match
16373 base_dir : subdir match
16374 base_dom : domain match
16375 base_end : suffix match
16376 base_len : length match
16377 base_reg : regex match
16378 base_sub : substring match
16379
16380base32 : integer
16381 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16382 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16383 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016384 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16385 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16386 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387
16388base32+src : binary
16389 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16390 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16391 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16392 per-URL counters.
16393
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016394capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16395 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16396 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16397 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16398
16399capture.req.method : string
16400 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16401 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16402 because it's allocated.
16403
16404capture.req.uri : string
16405 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16406 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16407 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16408 allocated.
16409
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016410capture.req.ver : string
16411 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16412 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16413 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16414
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016415capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16416 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16417 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16418 The first entry is an index of 0.
16419 See also: "capture response header"
16420
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016421capture.res.ver : string
16422 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16423 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16424 persistent flag.
16425
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016426req.body : binary
16427 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16428 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16429 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16430 the first chunk is analyzed.
16431
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016432req.body_param([<name>) : string
16433 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16434 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16435 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16436 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16437 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16438 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16439 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16440 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16441 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16442 given.
16443
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016444req.body_len : integer
16445 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16446 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16447 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16448 "option http-buffer-request".
16449
16450req.body_size : integer
16451 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16452 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16453 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16454 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16455 "option http-buffer-request".
16456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457req.cook([<name>]) : string
16458cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16459 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16460 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16461 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16462 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16463 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16464 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16465 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16466 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16467
16468 ACL derivatives :
16469 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16470 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16471 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16472 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16473 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16474 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16475 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16476 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016478req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16479cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16480 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16481 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16484cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16485 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16486 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16487 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16488 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16491 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16492 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16493 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16494 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016495 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16497 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16498 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16499 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016501hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16502 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16503 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16504 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16505 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016506 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016508req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16509 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16510 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16511 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16512 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16513 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16514 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16515 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16516 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16519 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16520 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16521 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16522 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16525 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16526 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16527 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16528 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16529 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16530 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16531 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16532 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016533 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016535 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016537 ACL derivatives :
16538 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16539 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16540 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16541 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16542 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16543 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16544 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16545 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16546
16547req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16548hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16549 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16550 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16551 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16552 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16553 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16554 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16555 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16556 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16557 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16558
16559req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16560hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16561 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16562 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16563 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16564 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16565 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016566 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016567 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16568 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16569
16570req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16571hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16573 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16574 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16575 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16576 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16577 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16578 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16579
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016580
16581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16583 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16584 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16585 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16586 basic auth is supported.
16587
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016588http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16589 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16590 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16591 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16592 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16594 basic auth is supported.
16595
16596 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016597 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16598 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16599 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16600 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016601
16602http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016603 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16604 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16606 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608method : integer + string
16609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16610 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16611 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16612 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16613 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16614 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16615 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617 ACL derivatives :
16618 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620 Example :
16621 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16622 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16623 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625path : string
16626 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16627 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16628 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16629 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16630 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016631 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634 ACL derivatives :
16635 path : exact string match
16636 path_beg : prefix match
16637 path_dir : subdir match
16638 path_dom : domain match
16639 path_end : suffix match
16640 path_len : length match
16641 path_reg : regex match
16642 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016643
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016644query : string
16645 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16646 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16647 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16648 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016649 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016650 which stops before the question mark.
16651
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016652req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16653 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16654 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16655 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16656 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658req.ver : string
16659req_ver : string (deprecated)
16660 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16661 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16662 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016664 ACL derivatives :
16665 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667res.comp : boolean
16668 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16669 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16670 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672res.comp_algo : string
16673 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16674 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16675 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677res.cook([<name>]) : string
16678scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16679 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16680 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16681 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683 ACL derivatives :
16684 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16687scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16688 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16689 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16690 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16693scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16694 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16695 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16696 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16699 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16700 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16701 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16702 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16703 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16704 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16705 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16706 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16707 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16710 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16711 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16712 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16713 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16714 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16717shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16718 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16719 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16720 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16721 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16722 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16723 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16724 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16725 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016727 ACL derivatives :
16728 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16729 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16730 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16731 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16732 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16733 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16734 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16735 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16736
16737res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16738shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16739 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16740 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16741 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16742 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16743 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16746shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16747 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16748 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16749 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16750 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16751 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16752 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016753
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016754res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16755 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16756 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16757 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16758 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16761shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16762 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16763 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16764 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16765 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16766 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16767 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016769res.ver : string
16770resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16771 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16772 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774 ACL derivatives :
16775 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016777set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16778 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16779 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016780 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016781 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16784 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786status : integer
16787 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16788 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16789 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016790
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016791unique-id : string
16792 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16793 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16794 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16795 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16796 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16797 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799url : string
16800 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16801 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16802 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16803 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16804 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16805 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16806 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808 ACL derivatives :
16809 url : exact string match
16810 url_beg : prefix match
16811 url_dir : subdir match
16812 url_dom : domain match
16813 url_end : suffix match
16814 url_len : length match
16815 url_reg : regex match
16816 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818url_ip : ip
16819 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16820 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16821 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16822 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16823 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16824 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16825 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827url_port : integer
16828 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16829 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16830 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16831 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016832
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016833urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16834url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16836 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016837 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16838 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16839 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16840 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16842 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016843 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16844 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846 ACL derivatives :
16847 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16848 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16849 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16850 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16851 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16852 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16853 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16854 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016855
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857 Example :
16858 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16859 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16860 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16861 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016862
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016863urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16865 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16866 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016867
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016868url32 : integer
16869 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16870 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16871 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16872 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16873 is an unsigned integer.
16874
16875url32+src : binary
16876 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16877 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16878 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16879
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016882---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16885every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016886order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016888ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16889---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016890FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016891HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016892HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16893HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016894HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16895HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16896HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16897HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16898LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016899METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016900METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016901METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16902METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16903METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16904METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016905METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016906METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016907RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016908REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016909TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016910WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16911---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016912
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169148. Logging
16915----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016917One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16918provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16919very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16920provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16921state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016922to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016923headers.
16924
16925In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16926about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16927send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16928
16929 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16930 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16931 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16932 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16933 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016934 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016935 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016936
16937The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16938allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16939as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16940while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16941real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16942delay.
16943
16944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169458.1. Log levels
16946---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016947
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016948TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016950HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16951in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16952track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16953syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16954about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016955
16956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169578.2. Log formats
16958----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016959
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016960HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016961and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16962slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16963options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016964
16965 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16966 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16967 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16968 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16969 extents.
16970
16971 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16972 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16973 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16974 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16975 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16976
16977 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16978 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16979 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16980 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16981 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16982
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016983 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16984 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16985 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16986 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16987
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016988 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16991specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16992field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16993servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16994always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16995identifier.
16996
16997Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16998 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16999 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17000 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17001 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17002
17003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170048.2.1. Default log format
17005-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006
17007This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17008as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17009format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17010
17011 Example :
17012 listen www
17013 mode http
17014 log global
17015 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17016
17017 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17018 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17019 (www/HTTP)
17020
17021 Field Format Extract from the example above
17022 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17023 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17024 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17025 4 'to' to
17026 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17027 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17028
17029Detailed fields description :
17030 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17031 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17032 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17033 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17034 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17035 and processed the connection.
17036 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17037
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017038In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17039"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17040connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17043will eventually disappear.
17044
17045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170468.2.2. TCP log format
17047---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017048
17049The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17050is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17051information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17052counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17053emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17054environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17055the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17056sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017057specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17058not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17059fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17060marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062 Example :
17063 frontend fnt
17064 mode tcp
17065 option tcplog
17066 log global
17067 default_backend bck
17068
17069 backend bck
17070 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17071
17072 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17073 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17074 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17075
17076 Field Format Extract from the example above
17077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17078 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17079 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17080 4 frontend_name fnt
17081 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17082 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17083 7 bytes_read* 212
17084 8 termination_state --
17085 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17086 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17087
17088Detailed fields description :
17089 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017090 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17091 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17092 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017093 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017094 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017095 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
17097 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017098 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17099 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17100 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101
17102 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17103 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17104 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017105 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17106 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17107 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17108 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109
17110 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17111 and processed the connection.
17112
17113 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17114 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17115 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17116 applications.
17117
17118 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17119 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17120 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17121 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17122 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17123
17124 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17125 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17126 See "Timers" below for more details.
17127
17128 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17129 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17130 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17131 "Timers" below for more details.
17132
17133 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017134 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017135 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17136 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17137 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17138 details.
17139
17140 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17141 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17142 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17143 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17144 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17145
17146 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17147 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17148 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17149 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17150 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17151 for more details.
17152
17153 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017154 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017155 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17156 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17157 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017158 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017159
17160 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17161 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17162 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17163 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17164 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17165 caused by a denial of service attack.
17166
17167 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17168 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17169 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17170 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17171 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17172 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17173 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17174 denial of service attack.
17175
17176 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17177 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17178 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17179 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17180 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17181 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17182 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17183 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17184 be processed than on other servers.
17185
17186 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17187 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17188 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17189 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17190 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17191 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17192 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17193 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17194 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17195 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17196 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17197 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17198 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17199
17200 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17201 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17202 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17203 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17204 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17205 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017206 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17208
17209 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17210 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17211 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17212 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17213 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17214 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017215 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017216 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17217 occurs.
17218
17219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172208.2.3. HTTP log format
17221----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222
17223The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17224is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17225the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17226are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17227emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17228generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17229"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17230which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017231frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17232is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017233
17234Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17235slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17236with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17237
17238 Example :
17239 frontend http-in
17240 mode http
17241 option httplog
17242 log global
17243 default_backend bck
17244
17245 backend static
17246 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17247
17248 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17249 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17250 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017251 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017252
17253 Field Format Extract from the example above
17254 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17255 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017256 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017257 4 frontend_name http-in
17258 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017259 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260 7 status_code 200
17261 8 bytes_read* 2750
17262 9 captured_request_cookie -
17263 10 captured_response_cookie -
17264 11 termination_state ----
17265 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17266 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17267 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17268 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17269 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017271Detailed fields description :
17272 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017273 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17274 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17275 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017276 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017277 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017278 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279
17280 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017281 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17282 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17283 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017284
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017285 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17286 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287
17288 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17289 and processed the connection.
17290
17291 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17292 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17293 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17294
17295 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17296 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17297 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17298 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17299 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17300 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017302 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17303 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17304 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017305 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017306 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17307 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017308 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17309 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017310
17311 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17312 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017313 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017314
17315 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17316 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017317 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17318 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319
17320 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17321 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17322 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17323 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17324 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017325 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17326 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017327
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017328 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17329 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17330 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17331 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17332 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17333 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17334 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017335 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17338 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17339 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17340
17341 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17342 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017343 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17345 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17346 overflowing.
17347
17348 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17349 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17350 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17351 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17352 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17353 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17354 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17355 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17356
17357 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17358 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17359 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17360 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17361 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17362 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17363 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17364 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17365
17366 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17367 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17368 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17369 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17370 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17371 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17372 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17373
17374 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017375 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17377 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17378 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017379 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380 system.
17381
17382 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17383 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17384 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17385 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17386 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17387 caused by a denial of service attack.
17388
17389 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17390 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17391 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17392 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17393 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17394 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17395 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17396 denial of service attack.
17397
17398 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17399 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17400 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17401 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17402 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17403 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17404 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17405 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17406 processed than on other servers.
17407
17408 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17409 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17410 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17411 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17412 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17413 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17414 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17415 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17416 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17417 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17418 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17419 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17420 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17421
17422 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17423 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17424 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17425 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17426 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17427 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017428 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017429 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17430
17431 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17432 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17433 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17434 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17435 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17436 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017437 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017438 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17439 occurs.
17440
17441 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17442 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17443 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17444 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17445 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17446 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17447 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17448 cookies" below for more details.
17449
17450 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17451 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17452 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17453 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17454 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17455 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17456 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17457 and cookies" below for more details.
17458
17459 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17460 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17461 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17462 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17463 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17464 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17465 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17466 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17467
17468
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200174698.2.4. Custom log format
17470------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017471
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017472The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017473mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017475HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017476Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17477separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17478prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17479
17480Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17481variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017482("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017483
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017484If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017485as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017486less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17487the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17488
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017489Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017490In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017491in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017492
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017493Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17494'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17495https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17496such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17497
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017498Flags are :
17499 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017500 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017501 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17502 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017503
17504 Example:
17505
17506 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17507 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17508
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017509 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17510
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017511At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17512
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017513 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17514 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017515
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017516the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017517
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017518 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17519 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17520 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017521
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017522and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17523
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017524 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17525 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017526
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017527Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17528
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017529 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017530 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017531 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17532 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17533 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017534 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17535 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17536 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017537 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017538 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17539 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017540 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017541 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17542 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017543 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017544 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017545 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017546 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017547 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017548 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017549 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017550 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17551 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17552 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17553 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17554 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017555 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017556 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17557 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017558 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017559 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17560 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017561 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17562 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17563 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017564 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017565 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17566 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017567 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017568 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17569 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17570 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017571 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017572 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017573 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17574 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17575 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17576 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017577 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017578 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017579 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017580 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017581 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017582 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017583 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17584 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17585 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017586 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017587 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17588 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017589 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017590 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17591 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017592 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017593 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017594 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017595 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017596
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017597 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017598
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017599
176008.2.5. Error log format
17601-----------------------
17602
17603When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17604protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17605By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17606"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017607will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017608logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17609
17610The format looks like this :
17611
17612 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17613 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17614 Connection error during SSL handshake
17615
17616 Field Format Extract from the example above
17617 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17618 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17619 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17620 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17621 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17622
17623These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17624failures.
17625
17626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176278.3. Advanced logging options
17628-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017629
17630Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17631just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17632options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17633for more information about their usage.
17634
17635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17637------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017638
17639It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17640haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17641commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17642monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17643ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17644
17645 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17646 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17647 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17648 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17649
17650 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17651 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17652 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017653 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654 such as other load-balancers.
17655
17656 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17657 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17658 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17659
17660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17662----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017663
17664The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17665what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17666or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017667"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17669log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17670after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17671is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17672with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17673with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17674
17675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17677------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017678
17679Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17680for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17681"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17682retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17683raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17684a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17685file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17686you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17687"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17688
17689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17691--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017692
17693Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17694multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17695them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17696"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17697logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17698error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17699and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17700too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17701useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17702alternative.
17703
17704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177058.4. Timing events
17706------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707
17708Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17709reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17710the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17711frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017712mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17713addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17714
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017715Timings events in HTTP mode:
17716
17717 first request 2nd request
17718 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17719 t tr t tr ...
17720 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17721 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17722 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17723 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17724 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17725
17726Timings events in TCP mode:
17727
17728 TCP session
17729 |<----------------->|
17730 t t
17731 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17732 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17733 |<------ Tt ------->|
17734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017735 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017736 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017737 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17738 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17739 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017740 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017741 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17742 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17743 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17744 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017745
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017746 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17747 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17748 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017749 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17750 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17751 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17752 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17753 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17754 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017755
17756 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17757 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17758 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17759 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17760 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17761 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17762 request typed by hand during a test.
17763
17764 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17765 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017766 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017767 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17768 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17769 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17770 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017771
17772 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17773 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17774 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17775 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17776 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17777
17778 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17779 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17780 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17781 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17782 connection never established.
17783
17784 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17785 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17786 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17787 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17788 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17789 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17790 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17791 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17792 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17793 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17794 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17795
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017796 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17797 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17798 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17799 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17800 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17801 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17802
17803 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17804
17805 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17806 "Ta" can never be negative.
17807
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17809 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017810 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17811 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017812 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017813
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017814 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017815
17816 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017817 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17818 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017819
17820These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17821protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17822that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017823due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17824"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17825that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017826
17827Most common cases :
17828
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017829 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17830 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17831 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17832 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17833 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17834 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17835 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17836 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17837 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17838 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17839 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017840 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841
17842 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17843 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17844 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17845 of ms on remote networks.
17846
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017847 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17848 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17849 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017851 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17852 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17853 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17854 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17855 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17856 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17857 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17858 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17859 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017860
17861Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17862
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017863 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017865 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017866
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017867 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017868 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17869 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17870
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017871 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017872 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17873 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17874 flags.
17875
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017876 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17877 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017878 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17879 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17880 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17881 the client connection was maintained open.
17882
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017883 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017884 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017885 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017886 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17887
17888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178898.5. Session state at disconnection
17890-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017891
17892TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17893"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
178942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17895each of which has a special meaning :
17896
17897 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17898 session to terminate :
17899
17900 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17901
17902 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17903 server explicitly refused it.
17904
17905 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17906 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17907 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17908 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017909 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017910
17911 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17912 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017913
17914 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17915 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17916 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17917 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17918 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17919
17920 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17921 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17922 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17923 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17924 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17925
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017926 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17927 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17928
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017929 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17930 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17931 backup connections when going up.
17932
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017933 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17934
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017935 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17936 send or receive data.
17937
17938 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17939 send or receive data.
17940
17941 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17942 with nothing left in the buffers.
17943
17944 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17945
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017946 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17948
17949 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17950 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17951 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17952 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17953 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17954
17955 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17956 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17957
17958 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17959 server (HTTP only).
17960
17961 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17962
17963 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17964 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17965 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17966
17967 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17968 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17969 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17970
17971 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17972
17973 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17974 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17975
17976 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17977 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17978 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17979
17980 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17981 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017982 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17983 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
17985 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17986 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17987 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17988 another server.
17989
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017990 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017991 server.
17992
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017993 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17994 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17995 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17996 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17997
17998 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17999 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18000 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18001 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18002
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018003 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18004 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18005 "use-server" rule).
18006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018007 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18008
18009 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18010 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18011
18012 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18013
18014 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18015 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18016 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18017
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018018 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18019 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018020 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018021 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18022 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018024 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18025
18026 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18027 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18028
18029 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18030
18031 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18032
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018033The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18034was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018035helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18036starvation, attacks, etc...
18037
18038The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18039alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18040easier finding and understanding.
18041
18042 Flags Reason
18043
18044 -- Normal termination.
18045
18046 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18047 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18048 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18049 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18050
18051 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18052 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18053 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18054 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18055 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18056 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018057
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018058 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18059 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018060 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018061
18062 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18063 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18064 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18065
18066 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18067 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18068 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18069 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18070 the server takes too long to respond.
18071
18072 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18073 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18074 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18075 long a time to respond.
18076
18077 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18078 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18079 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18080 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018081 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18082 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018083
18084 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18085 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18086 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18087 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18088 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018089 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018090 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18091 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18092 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18093 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18094 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18095 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18096 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18097 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018098 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018099 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18100 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18101 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102
18103 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18104 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018105 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18106 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18107 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18108 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018109
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018110 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18111 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018113 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18115 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018116 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18118 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18119
18120 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18121 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18122 503 or 504 here.
18123
18124 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18125 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18126 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18127 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18128 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18129
18130 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18131 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018132 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018133 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18134 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18135
18136 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18137 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18138 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18139 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18140 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18141 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18142 between haproxy and the server.
18143
18144 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18145 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18146 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18147 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18148 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18149 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18150 solution is to fix the application.
18151
18152 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18153 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18154 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18155 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18156 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18157 external attacks.
18158
18159 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18160 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018161 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018162 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18163 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18164
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018165 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18166 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18167 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018168 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018169 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018170
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018171 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18172 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18173 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18174 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018175 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18176 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18177 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18178 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18179 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
18181 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18182 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18183 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18184 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18185
18186 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18187 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18188 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18189 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18190
18191 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18192 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18193 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18194 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18195
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018196The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18197persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18198important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18199re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18200
18201 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18202
18203 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18204 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18205 set on a GET request.
18206
18207 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18208 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018209 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018210 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18211
18212 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18213 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18214 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18215
18216 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18217 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18218 already got a cookie.
18219
18220 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18221 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18222 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18223 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18224 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18225
18226 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18227 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18228 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18229
18230 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18231 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18232 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18233
18234 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18235 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18236
18237 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18238 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18239 then advertised in the response.
18240
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182428.6. Non-printable characters
18243-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018244
18245In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18246consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18247converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18248prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18249being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18250escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18251is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18252'}' when logging headers.
18253
18254Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18255issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18256containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18257
18258Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18259the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18260performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18261
18262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18264---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018265
18266Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18267achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018268section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018269cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18270the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18271the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018272locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018273not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18274user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18275a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18276wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18277
18278 Examples :
18279 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18280 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18281
18282 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18283 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18284
18285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18287---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018288
18289Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18290proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18291the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18292server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18293
18294Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18295response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018296section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018297
18298It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018299time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18300appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018301are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18302and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18303follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18304request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18305in the logs.
18306
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018307As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18308frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18309an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18310
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018311 Example :
18312 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18313 listen proxy-out
18314 mode http
18315 option httplog
18316 option logasap
18317 log global
18318 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18319
18320 # log the name of the virtual server
18321 capture request header Host len 20
18322
18323 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18324 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18325
18326 # log the beginning of the referrer
18327 capture request header Referer len 20
18328
18329 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18330 capture response header Server len 20
18331
18332 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18333 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18334
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018335 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018336 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18337
18338 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18339 capture response header Via len 20
18340
18341 # log the URL location during a redirection
18342 capture response header Location len 20
18343
18344 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18345 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18346 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18347 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18348 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18349
18350 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18351 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18352 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18353 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018354 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018355
18356 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18357 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18358 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18359 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18360 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018361 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018362
18363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183648.9. Examples of logs
18365---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018366
18367These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18368them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18369reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18370
18371 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18372 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18373 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18374
18375 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18376 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18377
18378 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18379 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18380 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18381
18382 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18383 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18384
18385 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18386 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18387 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18388
18389 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018390 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18392 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18393
18394 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18395 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18396 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18397
18398 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18399 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018400 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018401 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18402 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18403 to return the 502 and not the server.
18404
18405 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018406 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407
18408 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18409 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18410 Nothing was sent to any server.
18411
18412 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18413 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18414
18415 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18416 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018417 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018418 send a 408 return code to the client.
18419
18420 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18421 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18422
18423 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18424 5 seconds ("c----").
18425
18426 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18427 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018428 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018429
18430 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018431 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018432 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18433 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18434 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18435 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18436 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018437
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018438
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184399. Supported filters
18440--------------------
18441
18442Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18443accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18444unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18445
18446See also : "filter"
18447
184489.1. Trace
18449----------
18450
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018451filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018452
18453 Arguments:
18454 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18455 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18456
18457 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18458 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18459 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18460 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18461
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018462 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018463 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18464 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18465 amount of the parsed data.
18466
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018467 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018468
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018469This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18470callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18471information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18472filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18473
18474Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18475tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18476a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18477
18478
184799.2. HTTP compression
18480---------------------
18481
18482filter compression
18483
18484The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18485keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018486when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18487it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18488response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18489line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18490cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18491the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018492
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018493See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018494
18495
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200184969.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18497--------------------------------------------
18498
18499filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18500
18501 Arguments :
18502
18503 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18504 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18505 parsed.
18506
18507 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18508 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18509 part must be placed in its own scope.
18510
18511The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18512external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018513streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018514exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18515also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18516
18517SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18518the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18519
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018520For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018521"doc/SPOE.txt".
18522
18523Important note:
18524 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18525 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18526
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185279.4. Cache
18528----------
18529
18530filter cache <name>
18531
18532 Arguments :
18533
18534 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18535
18536The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18537"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018538cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018539other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18540the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18541mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18542filter other than the compression is used for the same
18543listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18544order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018545
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018546See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018547
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001854810. Cache
18549---------
18550
18551HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18552(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18553RAM.
18554
18555The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018556this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018557
18558If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18559independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18560when we try to allocate a new one.
18561
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018562The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018563
18564It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18565"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18566for more details.
18567
18568When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18569replaced by "<CACHE>".
18570
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001857110.1. Limitation
18572----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018573
18574The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18575
18576- If the response is not a 200
18577- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018578- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018579- If the response is not cacheable
18580
18581- If the request is not a GET
18582- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018583- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018584
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018585Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18586filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18587can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18588example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18589"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018590
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001859110.2. Setup
18592-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018593
18594To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18595the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18596
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001859710.2.1. Cache section
18598---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018599
18600cache <name>
18601 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18602 size of cache is mandatory.
18603
18604total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018605 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018606 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018607
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018608max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018609 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18610 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18611 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018612
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018613max-age <seconds>
18614 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18615 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18616 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18617 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18618 default.
18619
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001862010.2.2. Proxy section
18621---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018622
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018623http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018624 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18625 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18626 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18627 after this one.
18628
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018629http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018630 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18631 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18632 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18633 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18634
18635
18636Example:
18637
18638 backend bck1
18639 mode http
18640
18641 http-request cache-use foobar
18642 http-response cache-store foobar
18643 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18644
18645 cache foobar
18646 total-max-size 4
18647 max-age 240
18648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018649/*
18650 * Local variables:
18651 * fill-column: 79
18652 * End:
18653 */